Samsung Cell Phone SPS 1000 User Guide

SAMSUNG SPS 1000  
PROGRAM MANUAL  
1
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTENTS  
3
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GETTING STARTED  
REGISTER CONTROLS – DISPLAY ............................................................................13  
FRONT VIEW .......................................................................................................................................... 13  
DISPLAY ADJUSTMENTS ...................................................................................................................... 13  
REAR VIEW............................................................................................................................................. 13  
REGISTER CONTROLS – MODE LOCK......................................................................14  
MODE LOCK ........................................................................................................................................... 14  
DEFAULT KEYBOARD..................................................................................................16  
Essential Function Keys........................................................................................................................... 16  
ALPHA OVERLAY KEYBOARD ....................................................................................17  
ALPHA CODE PROGRAMMING...................................................................................18  
DISPLAY OPERATION – PAGE MOVEMENT..............................................................20  
DISPLAY OPERATION – FIELD SELECTION..............................................................21  
DISPLAY OPERATION – POP UP WINDOWS.............................................................22  
DISPLAY MESSAGES...................................................................................................25  
DISPLAY MESSAGES...................................................................................................26  
DISPLAY MESSAGES...................................................................................................27  
DISPLAY MESSAGES...................................................................................................28  
DISPLAY MESSAGES...................................................................................................29  
DISPLAY MESSAGES...................................................................................................30  
DISPLAY MESSAGES...................................................................................................31  
DISPLAY MESSAGES...................................................................................................32  
DISPLAY MESSAGES...................................................................................................33  
DISPLAY MESSAGES...................................................................................................34  
DISPLAY MESSAGES...................................................................................................35  
DISPLAY MESSAGES...................................................................................................36  
DISPLAY MESSAGES...................................................................................................37  
DISPLAY MESSAGES...................................................................................................38  
ERROR CLEAR INIT PROCEDURE...............................................................................40  
KEYBOARD CLEAR PROCEDURE...................................................................................41  
PROGRAM RESET .......................................................................................................45  
MEMORY ALLOCATION...............................................................................................46  
MEMORY ALLOCATION - DEFINITIONS...................................................................................47  
MEMORY ALLOCATION - DEFINITIONS...................................................................................48  
MEMORY ALLOCATION - DEFINITIONS...................................................................................49  
MEMORY ALLOCATION - DEFINITIONS...................................................................................49  
SELF TESTS .................................................................................................................52  
SELF TESTS - DEFINITIONS .......................................................................................53  
MEMORY CLEAR..........................................................................................................54  
MEMORY CLEAR - DEFINITIONS................................................................................55  
KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION ..................................................................................56  
KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION - DEFINITIONS.........................................................57  
FUNCTION KEY – LISTING ..........................................................................................58  
FUNCTION KEY – LISTING ..........................................................................................59  
FUNCTION KEY – LISTING ..........................................................................................60  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ..................................................................................61  
4
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ..................................................................................62  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ..................................................................................63  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ..................................................................................64  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ..................................................................................65  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ..................................................................................66  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ..................................................................................67  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ..................................................................................68  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ..................................................................................69  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ..................................................................................70  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ..................................................................................71  
S-MODE SYSTEM OPTIONS........................................................................................73  
S-MODE SYSTEM OPTIONS – DEFINITIONS.............................................................74  
PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS.................................................................................75  
PRINTER DRIVER DEFINITIONS......................................................................................76  
SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS.........................................................................77  
SERIAL PORT SELECTIONS - DEFINITIONS .............................................................78  
DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS...........................................................................79  
SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS - DEFINITIONS ................................................................80  
S-MODE PROGRAM SCANS........................................................................................81  
S-MODE PROGRAM SCANS........................................................................................82  
SYSTEM PASSWORD..................................................................................................83  
SUPER MACRO SCAN .................................................................................................84  
ROM FILE DOWNLOAD................................................................................................85  
ROM FILE DOWNLOAD................................................................................................86  
LOAD DEFAULT MESSAGES.......................................................................................87  
DEFAULT ERROR MESSAGES ...................................................................................88  
DEFAULT ERROR MESSAGES ...................................................................................89  
DEFAULT SYSTEM DESCRIPTORS............................................................................90  
UNLOCK PROCEDURES..............................................................................................91  
PLU – PROGRAMMING................................................................................................94  
PLU – DEFINITIONS .....................................................................................................95  
PLU – DEFINITIONS .....................................................................................................96  
PLU STATUS GROUP – PROGRAMMING...................................................................97  
PLU STATUS GROUP – DEFINITIONS........................................................................98  
PLU STATUS GROUP – DEFINITIONS........................................................................99  
PLU STATUS GROUP – DEFINITIONS......................................................................100  
GROUP – PROGRAMMING........................................................................................102  
GROUP – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................................103  
FUNCTION KEY – PROGRAMMING ..........................................................................104  
FUNCTION KEY – LISTING ........................................................................................105  
FUNCTION KEY – LISTING ........................................................................................106  
FUNCTION KEY – LISTING ........................................................................................107  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................108  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................109  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................110  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................110  
5
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................111  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................112  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................113  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................115  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................116  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................116  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................118  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................119  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................120  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................121  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................122  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................123  
SYSTEM OPTIONS......................................................................................................124  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................125  
GENERAL FUNCTION OPTIONS......................................................................................................... 125  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................126  
GENERAL FUNCTION OPTIONS......................................................................................................... 126  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................127  
GENERAL FUNCTION OPTIONS......................................................................................................... 127  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................129  
GENERAL FUNCTION OPTIONS......................................................................................................... 129  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................130  
GENERAL FUNCTION OPTIONS......................................................................................................... 130  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................131  
TAX OPTIONS....................................................................................................................................... 131  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................132  
CASH DRAWER OPTIONS................................................................................................................... 132  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................133  
TRAINING MODE OPTIONS................................................................................................................. 133  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................134  
LEVEL/MODIFIER OPTIONS................................................................................................................ 134  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................135  
TRACKING FILE OPTIONS .................................................................................................................. 135  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................136  
TRACKING FILE OPTIONS .................................................................................................................. 136  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................137  
KITCHEN PRINTING/VIDEO OPTIONS ............................................................................................... 137  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................138  
KITCHEN PRINTING/VIDEO OPTIONS ............................................................................................... 138  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................139  
VALIDATION/SUBTOTAL OPTIONS.................................................................................................... 139  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................140  
GENERAL PRINTING OPTIONS .......................................................................................................... 140  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................141  
GENERAL PRINTING OPTIONS .......................................................................................................... 141  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................142  
GENERAL PRINTING OPTIONS .......................................................................................................... 142  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................143  
GENERAL PRINTING OPTIONS .......................................................................................................... 143  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................144  
6
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REPORT PRINTING OPTIONS ............................................................................................................ 144  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................145  
REPORT OPTIONS............................................................................................................................... 145  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................146  
REPORT OPTIONS............................................................................................................................... 146  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................147  
TIME KEEPING OPTIONS.................................................................................................................... 147  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................148  
E.J. & Detail PRINTING OPTIONS........................................................................................................ 148  
TAX..............................................................................................................................149  
MESSAGES.................................................................................................................150  
DEFAULT ERROR MESSAGES .................................................................................151  
DEFAULT ERROR MESSAGES .................................................................................152  
DEFAULT SYSTEM DESCRIPTORS..........................................................................153  
WLU – WINDOW LOOK UP........................................................................................155  
WLU – WINDOW LOOK UP DEFINITIONS................................................................156  
TIME PERIOD .............................................................................................................157  
EMPLOYEE.................................................................................................................160  
EMPLOYEE - DEFINITIONS ............................................................................................161  
JOB CODE PROGRAM......................................................................................................................... 161  
PAY RATE PROGRAM.......................................................................................................................... 161  
AUTHORITY................................................................................................................162  
AUTHORITY – DEFINITIONS .....................................................................................163  
AUTHORITY – DEFINITIONS .....................................................................................164  
AUTHORITY – DEFINITIONS .....................................................................................166  
PRINTER TABLES AND KV ROUTING ......................................................................167  
SYSTEM PRINTER CONFIGURATION ......................................................................168  
KITCHEN VIDEO ROUTING .......................................................................................169  
KITCHEN PRINTER ROUTING...................................................................................170  
RECEIPT PRINTER ROUTING...................................................................................171  
DETAIL PRINTER ROUTING......................................................................................172  
INGREDIENT INVENTORY.........................................................................................173  
INGREDIENT – DEFINITIONS....................................................................................174  
EDIT INGREDIENT ............................................................................................................................... 174  
RECIPE TABLE ..................................................................................................................................... 174  
TIME ACTIVATED PROGRAM....................................................................................175  
TIME ACTIVATED – KEYBOARD LEVELS........................................................................176  
KEYBOARD LEVEL............................................................................................................................... 176  
TIME ACTIVATED – PRICE LEVELS..........................................................................177  
PRICE LEVEL........................................................................................................................................ 177  
TIME ACTIVATED – MACRO KEYS ................................................................................178  
MACROS ............................................................................................................................................... 178  
TIME ACTIVATED – STRING REPORTS..........................................................................179  
STRING REPORTS............................................................................................................................... 179  
TIME ACTIVATED – SHIFTS .........................................................................................180  
SHIFT..................................................................................................................................................... 180  
TIME ACTIVATED – KITCHEN PRINTING....................................................................181  
KP TIME PERIOD.................................................................................................................................. 181  
PRODUCT MIX GROUPS PROGRAM........................................................................183  
7
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PRODUCT MIX GROUPS– DEFINITIONS..................................................................184  
PRODUCT MIX GROUPS..................................................................................................................... 184  
PRODUCT MIX TIME PERIOD ............................................................................................................. 184  
MIX & MATCH TABLE PROGRAM .............................................................................185  
CUSTOM REPORT .....................................................................................................186  
CUSTOM REPORTS programming ...................................................................................................... 186  
CUSTOM REPORT - DEFINITIONS ................................................................................187  
CUSTOM REPORT – EDIT EXISTING REPORTS...............................................................188  
EDIT EXISTING REPORTS .................................................................................................................. 188  
STRING REPORT..............................................................................................................189  
STRING REPORT - DEFINITIONS.........................................................................................190  
PLU STOCK ENTRY ...................................................................................................191  
PLU STOCK ENTRY - DEFINITIONS ..............................................................................192  
PLU STOCK MENU............................................................................................................................... 192  
PLU STOCK ENTRY ............................................................................................................................. 192  
PLU MINIMUM STOCK PROGRAM ......................................................................................193  
COPY PROGRAM .............................................................................................................196  
COPY PROGRAM - DEFINITIONS.........................................................................................197  
COPY PLU............................................................................................................................................. 197  
COPY KEYBOARD LEVEL.................................................................................................................... 197  
COPY WLU (Window Look UP) ............................................................................................................ 197  
PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD....................................................................................198  
PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD....................................................................................199  
P-MODE PROGRAM SCANS......................................................................................200  
NON PLU CODE PROGRAM......................................................................................202  
NON PLU – DEFINITIONS ..........................................................................................203  
PLU & WLU KEY RELOCATION.................................................................................204  
PLU KEYS.............................................................................................................................................. 204  
WLU KEYS (Window Look Ups)............................................................................................................ 204  
BITMAP FILE DOWNLOAD.........................................................................................205  
X-MODE MANAGER MENU........................................................................................207  
Manager Operation................................................................................................................................ 207  
X-MODE REPORTS MENU.........................................................................................208  
TRAINING....................................................................................................................209  
SET DATE & TIME ......................................................................................................209  
CASH DECLARATION ................................................................................................210  
KEYBOARD & PRICE LEVEL .....................................................................................210  
TIME CLOCK EDIT......................................................................................................211  
X/Z1 (DAILY) TIME CLOCK EDIT ......................................................................................................... 211  
X/Z2 - X/Z5 TIME CLOCK EDIT ............................................................................................................ 211  
EDIT INVENTORY ITEM .............................................................................................212  
EDIT PLU STOCK .........................................................................................................213  
STOCK MENU....................................................................................................................................... 213  
DRAWER ASSIGNMENT PROGRAMMING ...............................................................214  
Z-MODE REPORTING ................................................................................................217  
Z-REPORTS.......................................................................................................................................... 217  
REPORT LIST .............................................................................................................219  
FINANCIAL......................................................................................................................221  
SALES BY TIME PERIODS................................................................................................223  
8
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLU..............................................................................................................................223  
PLU ZERO SALES ..........................................................................................................224  
PLU SALES BY PRICE LEVEL ..........................................................................................225  
MIX AND MATCH ............................................................................................................226  
NOT FOUND PLU ...........................................................................................................226  
EMPLOYEES...................................................................................................................227  
GROUPS BY EMPLOYEE ..................................................................................................229  
GROUP..........................................................................................................................230  
DRAWER TOTALS ...........................................................................................................230  
LABOUR GROUPS ...........................................................................................................232  
SALES AND LABOUR %....................................................................................................232  
DAILY SALES..................................................................................................................233  
GROUPS BY TIME PERIOD...............................................................................................233  
ANALYSIS 1 BY TIME PERIODS .....................................................................................233  
ANALYSIS 2 BY TIME PERIODS ........................................................................................234  
ANALYSIS 3 BY TIME PERIODS ........................................................................................234  
TRACK BY TIME PERIODS................................................................................................234  
OPEN CHECK.................................................................................................................235  
PRODUCT MIX................................................................................................................236  
PRODUCT PROJECTIONS .................................................................................................236  
STATION TOTALS............................................................................................................236  
TIME KEEPING ................................................................................................................237  
DAY SHIFT....................................................................................................................239  
INVENTORY ....................................................................................................................242  
INVENTORY DEFINITIONS ........................................................................................243  
PLU STOCK...................................................................................................................244  
PLU STOCK BY GROUP...................................................................................................244  
FOOD COST ...................................................................................................................244  
PLU MINIMUM STOCK.....................................................................................................246  
ELECTRONIC JOURNAL.....................................................................................................246  
BITMAP FILE DOWNLOAD.........................................................................................248  
PREPARE THE SPS1000 BITMAP DOWNLOAD................................................................................. 248  
BIT MAP FILE SPECIFICATION ........................................................................................................... 248  
BITMAP FILE DOWNLOAD.........................................................................................249  
DESIGN & SAVE A LOGO USING MICROSOFT PAINT...................................................................... 249  
PC- SETUP OF A BITMAP..........................................................................................250  
CONVERTING THE BITMAP FOR THE SPS1000 ............................................................................... 250  
DOWNLOADING THE BITMAP TO THE SPS1000.............................................................................. 250  
DOWNLOADING THE BITMAP FILE TO THE PRINTER..................................................................... 250  
PRINTING THE BITMAP IMAGE .......................................................................................................... 250  
PC- FLASH ROM DOWNLOAD...................................................................................250  
TO prepare receiving terminal ............................................................................................................... 251  
PC- FLASH ROM DOWNLOAD...................................................................................252  
TO TRANSMIT FROM THE PC..............................................................................................252  
PC ROM ERASE ................................................................................................................................... 252  
PC ROM DOWNLOAD .......................................................................................................................... 252  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – SCANNERS.................................................................254  
ZEEBEK SCANNER .............................................................................................................................. 254  
SYMBOL SCANNER ............................................................................................................................. 254  
9
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – SCANNERS.................................................................255  
METROLOGIC MS700 Scanner............................................................................................................ 255  
METROLogIC MS951 Scanner.............................................................................................................. 255  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – PRINTERS ..................................................................256  
PRINTER all samsung models .............................................................................................................. 256  
RJ45- PRINTER all samsung models.................................................................................................... 256  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – PC ...............................................................................257  
to P.C (Via Modem Connection) ........................................................................................................... 257  
DIRECT CABLE TO PC......................................................................................................................... 257  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – PC RJ45.......................................................................258  
(rj45) DIRECT CABLE TO PC ............................................................................................................... 258  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – IRC ..............................................................................259  
Two terminals......................................................................................................................................... 259  
To ETHERNET Hub............................................................................................................................... 259  
LOOP BACK CONNECTOR.................................................................................................................. 259  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – PERIPHERALS ...........................................................260  
SAMSUNG Pole Display........................................................................................................................ 260  
Epson DP101 / DP102 Pole Display...................................................................................................... 260  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – PERIPHERALS.................................................................261  
PORT LOCATIONS............................................................................................................................... 261  
RS232,IRC and cash drawer PIN LOCATIONS .................................................................................... 261  
10  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GETTING STARTED  
12  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REGISTER CONTROLS – DISPLAY  
FRONT VIEW  
(Option)  
DISPLAY ADJUSTMENTS  
REAR VIEW  
13  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REGISTER CONTROLS – MODE LOCK  
MODE LOCK  
OFF  
Use to void (correct) items outside of a sale.  
Note the void mode can be deactivated using a  
system flag.  
VOID  
VOID  
REG  
X
Z
The register is inoperable.  
Use for normal registrations.  
OFF  
REG  
PGM  
S MODE  
Use to read register reports and perform other  
manager functions.  
X
Z
Use to read register reports and reset totals to  
zero.  
Use to program the register.  
PGM  
Use for tests and special settings.  
This position is not marked on the key lock.  
S MODE  
The SPS 1000 includes two sets of keys that can be used to access the following key lock  
positions.  
POSITIONS ACCESSIBLE  
KEY  
OFF, REG  
REG  
VD  
Z
VOID, OFF, REG, X  
VOID,OFF, REG, X, Z  
VOID, OFF, REG, X, Z, PGM  
ALL POSITIONS  
P
C
14  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
15  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFAULT KEYBOARD  
ESSENTIAL FUNCTION KEYS  
The SPS 1000 keyboard is programmable; you can design a keyboard that fits your exact needs.  
The Samsung SPS 1000 requires you to place the following keys on every keyboard  
Numeric Keys 0-9  
CL/ESC  
YES/NO  
Cursor Control Keys UP/DOWN/LEFT/RIGHT  
PAGE UP/PAGE DOWN  
ENTER  
DONE  
X/TIME  
The factory default keyboard is shown below.  
CLERK  
1
CLERK  
2
CLERK  
3
CLERK  
4
CLERK  
5
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
26  
25  
24  
23  
22  
21  
20  
19  
18  
17  
16  
15  
14  
39  
38  
27  
26  
25  
24  
33  
32  
31  
30  
29  
28  
27  
52  
51  
50  
49  
48  
47  
46  
45  
44  
43  
42  
41  
40  
65  
64  
63  
62  
61  
60  
59  
58  
57  
56  
55  
54  
53  
78  
77  
76  
75  
74  
73  
72  
71  
70  
69  
68  
67  
66  
91  
90  
89  
88  
87  
86  
85  
84  
83  
82  
81  
80  
79  
104  
103  
102  
101  
100  
99  
MENU  
LEVL 1  
MENU  
LEVL 2  
MENU  
LEVL 3  
MENU  
LEVL 4  
MENU  
LEVL 5  
PRICE  
LEVL 1  
PRICE  
LEVL 2  
PRICE  
LEVL 3  
PRICE  
LEVL 4  
PRICE  
LEVL 5  
OPEN  
BAR  
TAB  
HOLD  
BAR  
TAB  
LIST  
BAR  
TABS  
REPEAT PRINT  
ORDER  
BILL  
OPEN  
CHECK  
NO.  
GUEST  
NO.  
TABLE  
NO.  
HOLD  
CHECK CHECKS  
LIST  
PAID  
RECALL  
WLU  
NO.  
YES/  
NO  
ENTER  
DONE  
8
EMPLO  
SIGN ON  
PAGE  
UP  
PAGE  
DOWN  
RECPT  
ISSUE  
UP  
7
98  
CLOCK  
IN/OUT  
RCPT  
ON/OFF  
LEFT  
DOWN  
RIGHT  
6
97  
CL/  
ESC  
PLU  
NO.  
X/  
TIME  
MISC  
TEND 2  
TRANS  
CANCEL  
5
96  
REFUND  
ITEM  
MISC  
TEND 1  
7
4
1
0
8
5
9
6
4
95  
ERROR  
CORRCT  
CHEQUE  
3
94  
RECVED  
MONIES  
SUB-  
TOTL  
2
3
.
2
93  
PAID  
OUT  
MONIES  
CASH  
00  
1
92  
16  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ALPHA OVERLAY KEYBOARD  
ALPHA CHARACTERS  
You have the option of using the Alpha Keyboard Overlay to enter descriptors (the default method) or  
you can enter descriptors by entering a three-digit character code for each character.  
(See System options-General Function Options in P-Mode Programming to select the method you want to program descriptors. )  
The key layout of the Alpha Keyboard Overlay is shown below:  
NOTE  
The DONE key acts as a backspace key when programming text.  
!
@
W
S
#
E
D
$
R
F
V
%
T
^
Y
H
N
&
U
J
*
I
(
)
P
:
-
+
;
_
=
"
?
[
|
\
'
Q
A
O
L
>
G
B
K
<
Z
X
C
M
,
.
/
CAPS  
SHIFT  
BOLD  
SPACE SPACE SPACE SPACE SPACE  
{
}
]
F
s
BACK  
SPACE  
ENTER  
¼
Ä
½
Å
ë
¾
Æ
ï
Ñ
T
X
PAGE  
UP  
PAGE  
DOWN  
UP  
C
Ö
Ü
É
ú
ù
¡ ¥  
y
PREV  
REC  
LEFT  
¢ ¯  
DOWN  
RIGHT  
CL/  
ESC  
NEXT  
REC  
DELETE  
á
é
í
ó
ò
à
è
ì
7
4
1
8
5
2
9
6
â
ê
î
ô
û
EURO  
¥ á  
ß
£
µ
¥
Ø
Pt  
3
.
¢
ƒ
0 00  
17  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ALPHA CODE PROGRAMMING  
ALPHA CODES  
You have the option of using the Alpha Keyboard Overlay to enter descriptors (the default  
method) or you can program descriptors by entering a three-digit character code for each  
character.  
(See System Options-General Function Options in P-Mode Programming to select the method you want to program descriptors)  
CODE  
CODE  
CODE  
CODE  
065  
066  
067  
068  
069  
070  
071  
072  
073  
074  
075  
076  
077  
078  
079  
080  
081  
082  
083  
084  
085  
086  
087  
088  
089  
090  
032  
097  
098  
099  
100  
101  
102  
103  
104  
105  
106  
107  
108  
109  
110  
111  
112  
113  
114  
115  
116  
117  
118  
119  
120  
121  
122  
048  
049  
050  
051  
052  
053  
054  
055  
056  
057  
033  
034  
035  
036  
037  
038  
039  
040  
041  
042  
043  
044  
045  
046  
047  
058  
059  
060  
061  
061  
063  
064  
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
a
b
c
d
e
f
g
h
i
j
k
l
m
n
o
p
q
r
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
!
#
$
%
&
(
)
*
+
,
-
.
/
:
<
=
>
?
@
156  
158  
159  
£
Pt  
Fr  
171  
172  
½
¼
s
t
u
v
w
x
y
z
Y
Z
SPACE  
;
NOTE  
The DONE key acts as a backspace key when programming text.  
18  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                                       
                                                                                       
↑ ↓  
                                                                                       
                                                                                       
↑ ↓  
DISPLAY OPERATION – CURSOR CONTROL  
While you are programming the SPS-1000, the bottom line of the screen displays the keys that  
you are allowed to use next. (These prompts do not display while operating the Samsung SPS  
1000 in the REG key lock position, or in manager operations.)  
For example, turn the key to the P position to view the P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU:  
CURSOR CONTROL  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
1. PLU  
L1  
2. PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. GROUP  
4. FUNCTION KEY  
5. SYSTEM OPTION  
6. TAXES  
Function keys that you  
are allowed to use are  
displayed at the bottom  
of the screen.  
7. MESSAGES  
8. WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
9. TIME PERIOD  
10. EMPLOYEE  
11. AUTHORITY LEVEL  
12. PRINTER TABLES & KV ROUTING  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
CHOOSING ITEMS FROM THE MENU  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
Choose an item from the menu  
in one of two ways:  
1. PLU  
2. PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. GROUP  
4. FUNCTION KEY  
5. SYSTEM OPTION  
6. TAXES  
7. MESSAGES  
8. WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
9. TIME PERIOD  
Type the number of your  
choice and press ENTER.  
Press the UP or DOWN  
keys to move the cursor to  
your choice and press  
ENTER.  
10. EMPLOYEE  
11. AUTHORITY LEVEL  
12. PRINTER TABLES & KV ROUTING  
The cursor  
automatically selects  
the first item when the  
menu screen is first  
opened.  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
19  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                                       
                                                                                       
DISPLAY OPERATION – PAGE MOVEMENT  
PAGE UP AND DOWN  
The scroll indicators tell  
you if the area in which  
you are working (in this  
case General Printing  
Options Programming  
area) contains more  
GENERAL PRINTING OPTIONS  
L1  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
1. PRINT ON RECEIPT:  
EMPLOYEE NAME  
CONSECUTIVE #  
ITEMS BY GROUP  
DATE  
TIME  
PREAMBLE/POSTAMBLE  
ORDER #  
SEAT #  
information than can be  
displayed at one time.  
Y
Arrow down indicates more  
information below. Press  
PAGE DOWN to view the  
information below that  
currently displayed.  
Y
00  
00  
00  
N
2. RECEIPT FEED LINES AFTER PRINT  
3. LINES AFTER PREAMBLE  
4. LINES BEFORE POSTAMBLE  
5. BUFFERED RECEIPT: Y=STUB/N=FULL  
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑ ↓ ← →  
GENERAL PRINTING OPTIONS  
L1  
Arrow up and down  
indicates more information  
above and below. Press  
PAGE DOWN to view the  
information below that  
currently displayed. Press  
PAGE UP to view the  
information above that  
currently displayed.  
6. PRINT RECEIPT WHEN SIGNING ON/OFF  
N
7. PRINT RECEIPT WHEN CLOCKING IN/OUT N  
8. CONDENSE TRAY SBTL RECEIPTS  
9. JOURNAL: Y=REAL TIME/N=BATCH  
10. PRINT PLU CODE WITH DESCRIPTOR  
11. TRANSACTION # IS RANDOM NUMBER  
12. HOME CURRENCY SYMBOL  
13. CONVERTED CURRENCY 1 SYMBOL  
14. CONVERTED CURRENCY 2 SYMBOL  
15. CONVERTED CURRENCY 3 SYMBOL  
16. CONVERTED CURRENCY 4 SYMBOL  
17. CONVERTED CURRENCY 5 SYMBOL  
18. PRINT TENDER ON RECEIPT  
N
N
N
N
£
@
@
@
@
Y
"
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↑ ↓ ← →  
20  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DISPLAY OPERATION – FIELD SELECTION  
SELECTING FIELDS  
PLU#000000000000000001 PROGRAMMING  
L1  
Press the UP or DOWN  
key to select the field  
above or below the current  
cursor position.  
DESCRIPTOR :  
STOCK LINK PLU#  
MODIFIER QTY 0000  
PLU1  
000000000000000000  
GROUP LINK # 1  
01  
01  
01  
PLU STATUS LINK  
#
PIECE COUNT  
ACTIVATE WLU#  
INACTIVE  
PRESET?  
000  
00  
N
RECIPE#  
With the field you wish to  
edit selected:  
MIX&MATCH TABLE# 01  
PRODUCT MIX# 01  
ALLOW PRICE CHANGE? N  
Y
For yes/no fields, press the  
YES/NO key to toggle from  
yes to no.  
ALLOW PRESET/HALO OVERRIDE?  
N
PRICE/HALO  
PRICE/HALO  
PRICE/HALO  
PRICE/HALO  
PRICE/HALO  
000000.00  
000000.00  
000000.00  
000000.00  
000000.00  
PRICE LEVEL#1? 01  
PRICE LEVEL#2? 02  
PRICE LEVEL#3? 03  
PRICE LEVEL#4? 04  
PRICE LEVEL#5? 05  
For fields that accept  
numeric values, type the  
appropriate value using  
numeric keys. Values that  
are not allowed will not be  
accepted.  
PLU# ESC Y/N ENT PAGE UP/DN ↑ ↓ ← →  
PLU#000000000000000001 PROGRAMMING  
L1  
Press ENTER to accept  
the new entry or press  
DOWN to accept the entry  
and advance to the next  
field  
DESCRIPTOR :  
STOCK LINK PLU#  
MODIFIER QTY 0000  
PLU1  
000000000000000000  
GROUP LINK # 1  
01  
01  
01  
PLU STATUS LINK  
#
PIECE COUNT  
ACTIVATE WLU#  
INACTIVE  
PRESET?  
000  
00  
N
RECIPE#  
MIX&MATCH TABLE# 01  
PRODUCT MIX# 01  
ALLOW PRICE CHANGE? N  
Press the LEFT or RIGHT  
key to select the field to the  
right or left of the current  
cursor position.  
Y
ALLOW PRESET/HALO OVERRIDE?  
N
PRICE/HALO  
PRICE/HALO  
PRICE/HALO  
PRICE/HALO  
PRICE/HALO  
000000.00  
000000.00  
000000.00  
000000.00  
000000.00  
PRICE LEVEL#1? 01  
PRICE LEVEL#2? 02  
PRICE LEVEL#3? 03  
PRICE LEVEL#4? 04  
PRICE LEVEL#5? 05  
PLU# ESC Y/N ENT PAGE UP/DN ↑ ↓ ← →  
21  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                                                                                                                                                   
                                                                                                                                                                                                   
                                                                                       
                                                                                       
                                                                                                                                                                                                     
                                                                                                                                                                                                     
                                                                                       
                                                                                       
DISPLAY OPERATION – POP UP WINDOWS  
OPENING POP-UP SELECTION WINDOWS  
GENERAL FUNCTION OPTIONS  
L1  
The arrow indicates the  
selections for this field are  
made from a pop-up  
window.  
1. MANAGER CONTROL (IN X-MODE):  
NEGATIVE SALES  
NEGATIVE TENDER  
ZERO SALES  
2. ENFORCE ANALYSIS1,2,3:  
AT BEGIN OF SALE  
BEFORE TENDER  
3. DEFAULT DESTINATION:  
4. ROUNDING ON % :  
N
N
N
With the field selected and the  
cursor on the arrow, press  
ENTER. A pop-up window  
displays with the selections for  
the field listed.  
N
N
NONE#  
UP AT .5$  
5. ROUNDING ON SPLIT PRICE/DECIMAL MULT  
UP AT .5$  
6. CONSOLIDATE LIKE ITEMS  
Y
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑ ↓ ← →  
GENERAL FUNCTION OPTIONS  
L1  
Press the UP or DOWN  
keys to make your choice,  
then press ENTER to close  
the pop-up window. Your  
new choice is displayed.  
1. MANAGER CONTROL (IN X-MODE):  
NEGATIVE SALES  
NEGATIVE TENDER  
ZERO SALES  
2. ENFORCE ANALYSIS1,2,3:  
AT BEGIN OF SALE  
N
N
N
N
N
BEFORE TENDER  
3. DEFAULT DESTINATION  
4. ROUNDING ON % :  
5. ROUNDING ON SPLIT PRICE/DT  
NONE#  
UP AT .5$  
NONE  
ANALYSIS 1  
5$  
ANALYSIS 2  
ANALYSIS 3  
6. CONSOLIDATE LIKE ITEMS  
Y
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑ ↓ ← →  
22  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
23  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DISPLAY MESSAGES  
24  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DISPLAY MESSAGES  
AMOUNT REQUIRED  
This operation requires an amount entry.  
BAD VALUE  
The number entered isincorrect for the task being performed.  
BUFFER FULL  
The buffer for soft check, hard check, or buffered receipt has reached capacity. For hard checks, the  
operator must press the SERVICE key to print the items and clear the buffer. The operator must then pick up  
the previous balance again in order to continue with finalisation. In a soft check environment, this message  
will appear when the check has reached capacity (maximum lines stored). The register will require the sale  
to be finalised with the option of printing a bill if required  
BUFFER EMPTY  
The buffer for WLU, REPEAT or PAID RECALL is empty.  
BUSY  
Destination register is busy (pre poll memory is in use). Requires a clear command from the P.C. or  
Register.  
CASH DECLARATION REQUIRED  
Cash declaration has been programmed as compulsory, and must first be performed before reports  
CASH-IN-DRAWER EXCEEDED  
The programmed Cash-In-Drawer limit has been exceeded.  
CHECK# ASSIGNED AUTO  
The operator has attempted to open a new guest check by assigning a check number. The register has been  
programmed to generate its own check numbers.  
CHECK# REQUIRED !  
This register has been programmed to force check number entry to begin a transaction. An existing guest  
check must be recalled, or a new one started.  
CONDIMENT REQUIRED!  
This PLU has been programmed to require a condiment entry.  
CRC ERROR  
An error has occurred in the block check sum while transferring data in IRC mode.  
25  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DISPLAY MESSAGES  
ANALYSIS 1/2/3  
This operation is set for compluslory entry of one of the three analysis keys.  
ENTER EMPLOYEE CODE  
The employee is required to sign on before performing a task.  
ENTER EMPLOYEE #  
The employee is required to sign on before performing a task.  
ENTER GUEST COUNT  
The operator must enter the number of guests when opening a guest check, or beginning a sale.  
ENTER SEAT#  
Seat # entry required before operation can continue.  
ENTER TABLE#  
Table number entry is required to open a guest check, or begin sale.  
ENTRY REQUIRED  
The function selected from the WLU requires a numeric entry, i.e. a percentage for an open percent  
discount.  
ERROR  
General error message.  
ERROR JAM  
Receipt / journal printer jammed message.  
TABLE NUMBER IN USE  
This check already exists.  
HALO OVER  
The amount entered exceeds the programmed HALO ie the task exceeds the maximum amount allowed.  
ILLEGAL KEY SEQUENCE  
The operator has used an illegal key sequence.  
IN USE!  
This guest check or clerk number is already open elsewhere in the system. This is also applicable when the  
floating clerk system is activated and the operator is in use on another terminal.  
26  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DISPLAY MESSAGES  
INACTIVE!  
The key pressed is inactive. This message also appears if VOID Mode has been disabled.  
INPUT QTY  
Quantity input is required for a condiment WLU  
KITCHEN PRINTER FAILURE  
The kitchen printer has failed to respond. Printing has been re-routed to the designated back-up printer is  
programed.  
MANAGER REQUIRED  
This operation requires the key to be turned to the X position.  
MANAGER OVERRIDE REQUIRE  
The key lock should be moved to the X-Mode position in order to override a HALO amount, or other  
restriction.  
MEMORY FULL  
Memory is full.  
NEGATIVE  
This sale has gone negative. Negative sales are programmed as not allowed.  
NO CHECK #  
This message appears when the system cannot find this guest check number.  
NO DATA  
PLU can not be found (does not appear in Register Mode). Usually associated with stock entry on an IRC  
system when the PLU exists in one terminal but not another. On the termianl where the PLU does not exist  
the message not found will appear.  
NO DRAWER!  
The employee currently signed on is not assigned to a drawer, and is not allowed to perform cash sales, or  
the drawer is no longer attached and is required in order to continue.  
NO MANUAL ENTRY  
Manual entry is not allowed (scale function).  
NO PAPER  
Slip printer is out of paper, appears when printing to a loose-leaf printer.  
27  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DISPLAY MESSAGES  
NO PLU!  
The number entered is not a valid PLU. This message will also appear if a PLU number “built” using modifier  
keys recalls an invalid PLU number.  
NON ADD# REQUIRED  
This operation requires the entry of a Non-Add number to fulfill the compulsory requirements.  
NOT DISCOUNTABLE  
The preceding entry is not discountable, product is not available for discounting.  
NOT PROGRAMMED!  
This key has not been programmed  
NOT READY!  
Remote printer is not ready for printing tasks.  
NOT ZERO  
Displayed when trying to delete a PLU that still has sales counts and stock amounts. The PLU must  
first be reset and cleared from all Z Mode reports.  
OFF LINE!  
IRC communications have gone off line.  
OPEN DRAWER  
The register has been programmed not to operate with the cash drawer open.  
P/BAL REQUIRED  
This register has been programmed to require a previous balance entry.  
PAPER END  
The guest check printer has reached the end of the form, or the Receipt/Journal paper is at, or near, the end  
of its roll.  
RANGE OVER  
The number entered is out of range.  
REMOVE PAPER  
Validation is complete and the paper must now be removed.  
28  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DISPLAY MESSAGES  
SCALE FAIL!  
The register is not able to find the scale.  
SCALE REQUIRED!  
This item requires a weight this may be entered either manually or automatically.  
SINGLE ITEM!  
This PLU has been programmed as a single item PLU and cannot be used within a sale.  
SUBTOTAL REQUIRED  
The SUBTOTAL key must be depressed before continuing.  
SYSTEM ERROR  
Normal Operation error.  
TARE# REQUIRED  
This PLU/scale item requires a tare weight entry.  
TRAY SUBTOTAL REQUIRED!  
This prompt appears while in a TRAY SUBTOTAL transaction. The operator must first press the TRAY  
SUBTOTAL key before pressing any tender keys.  
VALIDATION REQUIRED  
This operation requires validation to complete the compulsory settings.  
WASTE REQUIRED!  
The operator is in the middle of a waste operation, and must depress the WASTE key in order to complete  
the operation.  
WRONG EMPLOYEE  
The employee attempting to open this guest check is not the original person who started the guest check.  
Also appears when attempting to sign on a new employee without first signing the current employee off, if  
overlap employee is not programmed.  
SIGN OFF REQUIRED  
This operation requires a SIGN-OFF.  
ZERO AMOUNT  
The register has been programmed to not allow negative sales, and to consider a zero amount as a negative  
sale.  
29  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DISPLAY MESSAGES  
PRICE LEVEL MISMATCH  
This PLU has no price that corresponds to the current price level.  
OVERRIDE NOT ALLOWED  
X-Mode override is not allowed for this operation.  
WRONG SEQUENCE  
The preceding key sequence is not allowed.  
WRONG FILE NO  
The file number do not match.  
WRONG ITEMMIZER  
Wrong itemmizer encountered.  
UNDER TEND NOT ALLOWED  
The under tendering is not allowed.  
OVER TEND NOT ALLOWED  
The over tendering is not allowed.  
CHECK TRACKING ERROR  
Error occurred during check tracking operation.  
CHECK# IN USE  
Current check number is already in use.  
PLU NOT ALLOWED  
PLU is not allowed in this operation.  
CONDIMENT PLU NOT ALLOWED  
Condiment PLU is not allowed in this operation.  
NON-CONDIMENT PLU NOT ALLOWED  
Non-Condiment PLU is not allowed in this operation.  
FUNCTION KEY NOT ALLOWED  
Function key is not allowed in this operation.  
30  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DISPLAY MESSAGES  
THIS KEY NOT ALLOWED  
This key is not allowed in this operation.  
NO FUNCTION KEY  
This key is not a function key.  
NO PROGRAMMABLE KEY  
This function key is not a programmable key.  
X/TIME REQUIRED  
This operation requires X/TIME.  
INVALID AUTHORITY LEVEL  
The authority level of the employee signed on does not allow this operation.  
TIME IN REQUIRED  
This operation requires TIME IN.  
SIGN ON REQUIRED  
This operation requires SIGN ON.  
MEMORY NOT ALLOCATED  
This report or programming file is not allocated in memory allocation.  
THIS EMP. RPT MUST BE CLEARED  
Issue the Z report of this employee in order to assign this employee to training employee file #.  
ERROR STATUS  
Current operation is not correct.  
ERROR VALUE  
The number entered is incorrect for the task being performed.  
ERROR SYSTEM OPTION  
System option error. Please check the appropriate system option in PGM or S mode.  
ERROR EMPLOYEE  
31  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This employee is not acceptable.  
DISPLAY MESSAGES  
ERROR TABLE NO  
Wrong table number entered.  
SCALE MOTION  
The scale is not settled down.  
OVER WEIGHT  
Weight is over the weighing capacity of scale.  
UNDER WEIGHT  
Weight is under the weighing capacity of scale.  
PROMO NOT ALLOWED  
This PLU does not allow promo operation. Please check the programming of PLU status group linked to this  
PLU.  
WASTE NOT ALLOWED  
This PLU does not allow waste operation. Please check the programming of PLU STATUS GROUP linked to  
this PLU.  
NO FOOD STAMP AMOUNT  
No food stamp eligible amount.  
DECIMAL ENTRY NOT ALLOWED  
The decimal entry is not allowed.  
SPLIT PRICING NOT ALLOWED  
The split pricing is not allowed.  
VOID MODE IS DEACTIVATED  
The transaction in VOID mode is deactivated. Please check the GENERAL FUNCTION OPTIONS.  
JOB CODE REQUIRED  
There is the part that do not include job code.  
JOB CODE CHANGE NOT ALLOWED  
32  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
JOB CODE change is not allowed. Please check the programming of AUTHORITY LEVEL linked to the  
employee.  
DISPLAY MESSAGES  
PUSH BUTTON ENTRY REQUIRED  
Please use any of the 10 direct employee keys to sign on by direct key depression.  
EMPLOYEE CODE NOT LINKED  
The employee # is not linked this direct employee key. Please assign the employee # in GENERAL  
FUNCTION OPTIONS.  
TENDERING IS NOT ALLOWED  
This employee can do GUEST CHECK ENTRIES ONLY. Please check the programming of AUTHORITY  
LEVEL linked to the employee.  
OVER REGULAR HOURS PER WEEK  
The entered data exceeds the regular hours per week. Please check the TIME KEEPING OPTIONS  
programming.  
MUST <= LINE# PER TRANSACTION  
# of lines per soft check should be less than or equal to # of lines per transaction.  
MUST >= LINE# PER SOFT CHECK  
# of lines per transaction should be more than or equal to # of lines per soft check.  
NO STOCK PLU  
This PLU is not a STOCK PLU. Please check the programming of PLU status group linked to this PLU.  
NEGATIVE CARD  
Negative value not allowed.  
LINKED STATUS REQUIRED  
This PLU requires the linked PLU STATUS GROUP.  
RETURN TO X-MODE  
In order to exit the EDIT INVENTORY ITEM, the returning to X mode is required.  
ERROR - SLIP PAPER  
Error in printing on Slip printer.  
33  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LOCAL PRINTER REQUIRED  
The local printer connected to this register is required.  
DISPLAY MESSAGES  
MODE ERROR  
The mode should not be changed because the current task is not completed.  
SET TIME&DATE IS DEACTIVATED  
The setting time & date is deactivated. Please check the GENERAL FUNCTION OPTIONS programming.  
EMPLOYEE SHOULD BE DIFFERENT  
The TO EMPLOYEE should be different from the FROM EMPLOYEE in transfer check.  
TRANSFER NOT ALLOWED  
TRANSFER CHECK is not allowed. Please check the programming of AUTHORITY LEVEL linked to the  
employee.  
REQ GALLONAGE AMOUNT  
This entry involves a gallonage PLU, and requires an amount entry.  
AVAILABLE ONLY IN CHECK  
This operation is available only if check is opened.  
SPLIT THIS ITEM NOT POSSIBLE  
No more splitting this item is allowed.  
FUNCTION KEY NOT INCLUDED  
There is no function key in this WLU.  
ERROR POST TENDER  
Error in post tender operation.  
NO TRACKING DATA IN THIS REG  
There is no check tracking data in this register. Please check the S-MODE SYSTEM OPTIONS  
programming.  
NO TIME KEEP DATA IN THIS REG  
There is no time in/out data in this register. Please check the S-MODE SYSTEM OPTIONS programming.  
34  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MULTIPLICATION LIMIT EXCEEDED  
The entered multiplier exceeds the direct multiplication maximum digit. Please check the GENERAL  
FUNCTION OPTIONS programming.  
DISPLAY MESSAGES  
TAB OF FIELD2 TOO BIG  
TAB OR DECIMAL POINT OF FIELD 2 should be less than or equal to LENGTH OF FIELD 2.  
NON-PLU CODE RANGE OVER  
The digit of PLU code according to programming exceeds the digit of real PLU code.  
TARE ENTRY NOT ALLOWED  
Tare weight entry is not allowed. Please check the SCALE key programming.  
MISC TEND REQUIRED  
Any of the 16 MISC TEND keys is required for the task being performed.  
NOT SCALEABLE PLU  
This PLU is not a scaleable PLU. Please check the programming of PLU status group linked to this PLU.  
EJ BUFFER FULL  
Electronic Journal buffer is full.  
MUST BE START<=END IN RANGE  
START should be less than or equal to END in one range.  
RANGE OVERLAP  
START should be more than END of the preceding range.  
FINAL END SHOULD BE 9 OR 99  
END of the final range should be 9 or 99.  
NOT PLU  
The key that will be relocated should be PLU key.  
NOT WLU  
The key that will be relocated should be WLU key.  
PRINT KEY REQUIRED  
35  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PRINT key is required for the task being performed.  
SURCHARGE NOT ALLOWED  
This PLU does not allow surcharge operation. Please check the programming of PLU STATUS GROUP  
linked to this PLU.  
DISPLAY MESSAGES  
DECIMAL ENTRY REQUIRED  
The weight entry using DECIMAL key is required.  
SYSTEM REG# REQUIRED  
Please assign the appropriate register # to IRC FROM and IRC TO REGISTER # in S-MODE SYSTEM  
OPTIONS.  
TRAINING EMP FILE# REQUIRED  
Please assign the employee # to TRAINING EMPLOYEE FILE # in TRAINING MODE OPTIONS.  
TIME IN/OUT REG# REQUIRED  
Please assign the register # to REG# HOLDS TIME IN/OUT DATA in S-MODE SYSTEM OPTIONS.  
CHECK TRACKING REG# REQUIRED  
Please assign the register # to REG# HOLDS CHECK TRACKING DATA in S-MODE SYSTEM OPTIONS.  
ELECTRONIC JOURNAL INACTIVE  
ELECTRONIC JOURNAL is inactive. Please check the E.J. & DETAIL PRINTING OPTIONS programming.  
CHEQUE ENDORSEMENT REQUIRED  
CHEQUE ENDORSEMENT key is required for the task being performed.  
EFT TERMINAL TRANS.KEY ERROR  
The TRANSACTION KEY of EFT Terminal connected to entered key is incorrect. Please check the  
FUNCTION KEY programming.  
CARD ERROR  
General card error message.  
PRINTER OFFLINE  
Printer is off line.  
KV OFFLINE  
KV is off line.  
36  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NO RELOCATABLE KEY  
This key is no relocatable key.  
CLERK KEY ERROR  
Wrong operation with real clerk key.  
DISPLAY MESSAGES  
ENFORCE ACTUAL INVENTORY  
Please input ACTUAL INVENTORY at EDIT INVENTORY ITEM in X mode.  
AUTHORITY LEVEL NOT LINKED  
Authority Level should be linked to this employee.  
WEIGHT IS ZERO  
Weight on the scale is zero.  
STOCK IS NOT ZERO  
The STOCK of this PLU is not zero.  
CLEAR CAN NOT BE REMOVED  
If this position is relocated by other key except CLEAR key, CLEAR key will disappear on this keyboard.  
Please leave one CLEAR key at least.  
ENTER CAN NOT BE REMOVED  
If this position is relocated by other key except ENTER key, ENTER key will disappear on this keyboard.  
Please leave one ENTER key at least.  
YES/NO CAN NOT BE REMOVED  
If this position is relocated by other key except YES/NO key, YES/NO key will disappear on this keyboard.  
Please leave one YES/NO key at least.  
THIS NUMERIC CAN’T BE REMOVED  
If this position is relocated by other key except this numeric key, this numeric key will disappear on this  
keyboard. Please leave one this numeric key at least.  
INCORRECT CODE  
There is no code that matched with the entered code.  
SOFT CHECK ONLY  
This operation can be done in only SOFT CHECK.  
37  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INACTIVE PLU  
This PLU is inactive PLU.  
MULTIPLE DISCOUNT NOT ALLOWED  
Multiple Discount is not allowed.  
DISPLAY MESSAGES  
NEW CHECK OPENED  
The requested check does not exist so a new check is opened.  
NO MORE SPLIT TENDER ALLOWED  
No more split tender is allowed.  
CHECK POLE DISPLAY  
Pole display is turned off or disconnected, check the pole display.  
MUST MAX.NONTAXABLE<=BRK PNT1  
MAXIMUM NON-TAXABLE AMOUNT should be less than or equal to BREAK POINT 1.  
MUST BRK PNT N <= BRK PNT N+1  
BREAK POINT should be less than or equal to the next BREAK POINT.  
NOT ALLOWED WITH OPEN ORDERS  
Z with open order is not allowed. Please check the REPORT OPTIONS programming.  
NOW POLLING !!  
Prepolling operation is in progress.  
MIX AND MATCH ERROR  
Wrong mix & match operation.  
CLERK INTERRUPT ERROR  
Clerk interrupt is not allowed or wrong operation was done.  
CHECK OPENED NO DATA  
NEW CHECK# key can not open a check.  
NO CLERK BUFFER IN THIS REG  
There is no clerk interrupt data in this register. Please check the S-MODE SYSTEM OPTIONS  
programming.  
38  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
RESET PROCEDURES  
39  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ERROR CLEAR INIT PROCEDURE  
The initial clear function allows you to exit any register activity and return to a beginning or cleared  
state. any transaction in progress will be exited and totals for that transaction are not updated.  
Here are some reasons you may want to perform an initial clear:  
The register is in an unknown state, and you wish to exit the current  
program or transaction without following normal procedures.  
You have performed a function that includes a compulsory activity,  
such as validating or printing, and you wish to bypass the  
compulsory activity.  
An initial clear may be necessary as part of servicing, or  
troubleshooting an SPS 1000 register or system.  
Contact your SAMSUNG dealer first if you have questions about operating or programming your  
SPS-1000.  
TO PERFORM AN INIT CLEAR  
1. Turn the power switch located on the right side of the register to the  
OFF position.  
2. Turn the key lock to the PGM key lock position.  
3. Press and hold the key position where the CASH key is located on the  
default keyboard layout.  
4. Continue to hold the CASH key whilst turning the power switch to the  
ON position.  
5. The P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU will display when the initial clear  
is complete.  
7
4
1
0
8
5
9
6
TEND 1  
CHEQUE  
TO INITIALIZE:  
SUB-  
TOTL  
Press and hold this key position  
during power-up in P-mode.  
2
3
.
CASH  
00  
40  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NOTE it may be required in some instances after a program init procedure to return to the REG position and press a  
tender key to complete the procedure  
KEYBOARD CLEAR PROCEDURE  
CAUTION: Distribute the S-Mode key only to those you may want to perform  
this function.  
The keyboard clear function allows you to reset the custom keyboard back to factory settings  
Here are some reasons you may want to perform an initial clear:  
Some or all of the essential Functions keys have been  
inadvertently programmed as other functions  
The custom-programmed keyboard is not required.  
Contact your SAMSUNG dealer first if you have questions about operating or programming  
your SPS-1000.  
TO PERFORM KEYBOARD CLEAR  
1. Turn the power switch located on the right side of the register to  
the OFF position.  
2. Turn the key lock to the S-MODE position (one position clockwise  
from the PGM key lock position).  
3. Press and hold the key position where the SUB-TOTL key is  
located on the default keyboard layout.  
4. Continuing to hold the SUB-TOTL key whilst turning the power  
switch to the ON position.  
5. The S-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU will be displayed when this  
procedure has been completed.  
41  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7
4
1
0
8
5
9
6
TEND 1  
CHEQUE  
TO INITIALIZE:  
SUB-  
TOTL  
Press and hold this key position  
during power-up in S-MODE  
2
3
.
CASH  
00  
42  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
43  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
S-MODE  
CAUTION:  
S-Mode functions are reserved for system providers who set-up and service your SPS1000  
system.  
The user will normally perform no S-Mode functions.  
The procedures described in this area are security sensitive.  
Many S-Mode functions, including memory clearing and memory allocation, will cause  
significant damage or loss to the user if they are performed without first backing up register  
data.  
A special S-Mode key secures this mode, which is, located in an unmarked position one  
point clockwise from the PGM key lock position.  
Distribute the special S-Mode key only to those you may want to perform these functions.  
44  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PROGRAM RESET  
CAUTION: This will reset all programmed information, setting the machine  
back to factory default settings  
This procedure will reset the machine back to factory settings, ready to commence program.  
There a two options for resetting; the first will load the default settings into the terminal,  
ready to commence programming. The second will prompt for user input of the file sizes.  
The first option is ideal for setting up demonstrations; the second is normally used for  
custom installations  
TO A COMPLETE PROGRAM RESET  
1. Turn the power switch located on the right side of the register to  
the OFF position.  
2. Turn the key lock to the S-MODE position (one position clockwise  
from the PGM key lock position).  
3. Press and hold the key position where the CHEQUE key is located  
on the default keyboard layout.  
4. Continue to hold the CHEQUE key whilst turning the power switch  
to the ON position. (see figure 1)  
5. Press each of the four corner keys  
TOP LEFT, BOTTOM LEFT, TOP RIGHT, BOTTOM RIGHT (see  
figure 2)  
6. You will be prompted as to whether you wish to load the default  
memory allocation, this is ideal for demonstrations as all defaults  
are set, and the terminal is immediately ready for feature  
programming. The alternative is to answer no and you will be  
prompted to enter your own file sizes, ideal for setting up custom  
installations. (see following for custom allocation definitions)  
Figure 1.  
1st  
Figure 2.  
3rd  
7
4
1
0
8
9
6
T E N D  
1
Press and hold  
this key  
position  
during power-  
up in S-  
MODE  
Press each of  
the four  
corner keys in  
turn  
C H E Q U E  
5
S U B -  
T O T L  
2
3
.
C A S H  
0 0  
2nd  
4th  
45  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                              
                              
                                                                                                                    
                                                                                                                     
MEMORY ALLOCATION  
The Memory allocation is requested when the machine is program reset and default memory  
allocation is declined. The information can be displayed at any time by selection S-MODE  
option memory allocation.  
The following entries define the file sizes for the terminal; once they have been entered they  
are fixed and can not be changed without program resetting the machine. All terminals within  
an IRC (inter register communications) system should ideally have identical memory  
allocations.  
MEMORY ALLOCATION PROGRAMMING L1  
MEMORY ALLOCATION PROGRAMMING L1  
1. # OF DIGITS IN REPORT TOTALS (8-10) 08  
12. # OF LINES PER CHECK/INTERRUPT 030  
2. # OF DIGITS IN REPORT COUNTERS(6-8)6  
13. # OF LINES PER TRANSACTION  
050  
3. # OF PLU  
00220  
0010  
4
Y
005  
14. MAXIMUM # OF CHECKS (ALL FILES)00010  
4. # OF PLU STATUS GROUPS  
5. # OF PRICE LEVELS PER PLU (1-5)  
6. PLU REPORT BY PRICE LEVEL  
7. # OF EMPLOYEE  
15. # OF TIME PERIOD (24/48/96)  
16. # OF PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
24  
005  
17. # OF PROD MIX TIME PRDS (24/48/96) 24  
18. PROJECTIONS  
19. # OF WLU  
20. # OF LINES PER WLU  
21. # OF RECIPE  
22. # OF INVENTORY INGREDIENT  
N
010  
10  
005  
015  
8. # OF TIME ENTRIES PER EMPLOYEE 24  
9. USE GROUP BY EMPLOYEE  
10. CHECK TRACKING METHOD  
11. CHECK TRACKING FILES (0-4)  
N
SOFT  
2
REMAINING MEMORY IS  
6996 BYTES  
REMAINING MEMORY IS  
"
6996 BYTES  
!
ESC Y/N
 
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓←→  
ESC Y/N
 
ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓←→  
MEMORY ALLOCATION PROGRAMMING L1  
MEMORY ALLOCATION PROGRAMMING L1  
23. # OF LINES FOR ELECT. JOURNAL 00000  
34. CLERK INTERRUPT  
Y
24. # OF PAID RECALL TRANSACTIONS  
25. # OF KEYSTROKES IN SUPER MACRO 0020  
26. STORE BITMAP  
27. ANALYSIS1 BY TIME PERIODS  
28. ANALYSIS2 BY TIME PERIODS  
29. ANALYSIS3 BY TIME PERIODS  
30. TRACK 1 BY TIME PERIODS  
31. TRACK 2 BY TIME PERIODS  
32. TRACK 3 BY TIME PERIODS  
33. TRACK 4 BY TIME PERIODS  
03  
35. # OF MIX & MATCH  
36. REPORT SELECTION TABLE  
05  
Z1 Z2 Z3 Z4 Z5  
Y Y N N N  
Y N N N N  
Y N N N N  
Y N N N N  
N
Y
Y
Y
Y=YES, N=NO  
FINANCIAL  
EMPLOYEE  
PLU  
Y
GROUP  
Y
N
N
GROUP BY TIME PERIOD Y N N N N  
TIME PERIOD  
TIME KEEPING  
Y N N N N  
Y N N N N  
Y N N N N  
6996 BYTES  
MIX & MATCH  
REMAINING MEMORY IS  
6996 BYTES  
REMAINING MEMORY IS  
%
ESC Y/N
 
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓←→  
"
ESC Y/N
 
ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓←→  
46  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MEMORY ALLOCATION - DEFINITIONS  
# OF DIGITS IN REPORT TOTALS (8 - 10)  
This is the length of the value field on read and reset reports  
# OF DIGITS IN REPORT COUNTERS (8 - 10)  
This is the length of the quantity field on read and reset reports  
# OF PLU  
This is the maximum number of PLUs (Price Look-Ups) you require in the system  
# OF PLU STATUS GROUPS  
This is the maximum number of Status Groups. These are used to program common system flags to a group of  
PLUs and are required by the system.  
# OF PRICE LEVEL PER PLU (1 - 5)  
This is the number of price levels per PLU. Each product has the ability to use five prices selected from twenty  
price bands. This allows the user to create a matrix of products, selected for sale using the correct price key. This  
also provides detailed report when used with the PLU report by price level.  
PLU REPORT BY PRICE LEVEL  
It is possible to produce a read and reset report listing the sales quantity and value for each of the five prices used  
per product, also providing an overall analysis of the sales quantities and values for the each price level.  
# OF EMPLOYEES  
This is the number of operators for the system also including the total number of employees available for the time  
clock wage calculation feature. In order to produce the optional training financial report, include an additional  
employee.  
# OF TIME ENTRIES PER EMPLOYEE  
This is the number of times an employee can clock into the system before a daily time keeping reset report is  
required to be printed. (I.e. the number of shifts per day)  
USE GROUP BY EMPLOYEE  
This used to provide additional labour and employee reporting analysis. I.e. the number of hours worked per job  
type  
CHECK TRACKING METHOD (SOFT / HARD)  
This is the method by which balances can be stored within the system. Soft refers to a complete detailed analysis  
with all product sales stored and printed. Hard refers to balance only storage.  
47  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MEMORY ALLOCATION - DEFINITIONS  
# OF TRACKING FILES (0 - 4)  
The norm is to have one tracking file for table detail storage. This however can be increased to four, each running  
independently. This could be utilised to provide storage for Tables. Bar Check, Room Tabs, etc.  
There is the additional option of providing a history for closed soft checks, Tracking file 2 will store closed  
checks for tracking file one and tracking file 4 will store 3, Normal tracking with not be done on files 3 and 4  
whilst they are allocated to store history. The number of lines before wrap round begins is set in memory using #  
of lines per check.  
# OF LINES PER CHECK/INTERRUPT  
This is the maximum number of product lines that can be stored per check, also when using clerk interrupt this is  
the number of lines that can be stored per clerk. This field also controls the number of history lines that can be  
stored for closed check tracking files before wrap round reporting begins.  
# OF LINES PER TRANSACTION  
This is the maximum number of products, which can be sold per transaction and must be greater than the number  
of lines per check/interrupt.  
MAXIMUM # OF CHECKS (ALL FILES)  
This is the maximum number of checks that can be opened at once. The value you enter here provides that  
maximum for all of the check tracking files selected.  
For example Entering 50 here will allow 50 checks for tracking file 1, and another 50 checks for tracking file 2  
etc.  
# OF TIME PERIOD (24 / 48 / 96)  
This is the number of time periods by which information will be analysed. This can be either 24-hourly, 48 - 1/2  
hourly, 96 - 15 minutes. Further programming allows suppression and edit of any time report within the chosen  
range  
# OF PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
Product mix groups are used individual or for a group of products, providing an outer and single unit usage  
analysis The analysis is automatically updated when products are sold and no maintenance tasks are required by  
the user.  
# OF PROD.MIX TIME PRDS (24 / 48 / 96)  
This is the number of time periods by which information will be analysed. This can be either 24-hourly, 48 - 1/2  
hourly, 96 - 15 minutes. Further programming allows suppression and edit of any of the time periods within the  
chosen range.  
PROJECTIONS  
The product mix usage per time period can be used for defined weekly projections of product usage. This is in  
addition to the normal product usage, analysis report.  
48  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MEMORY ALLOCATION - DEFINITIONS  
# OF WLU (WINDOW LOOK UP UNITS)  
This is the maximum number of window look-up menus available for PLU, Condiment and Function keys  
grouped together for display/selection.  
# OF LINES PER WLU (WINDOW LOOK UP UNITS)  
This is the maximum number of items available for selection within one window.  
# OF RECIPE  
Recipes can be used for stock control, When a product is sold; the information will be automatically calculated  
back through the recipe file in order to deduct the stock from the relevant ingredients. This is the maximum  
recipes available  
# OF INVENTORY INGREDIENT  
This is the maximum number of ingredients required for recipe inventory stock control on the whole system.  
# OF LINES FOR ELECT. JOURNAL  
This is the maximum number of lines available for the journal storage area before a reset report is required, one  
line is required for each line of normal print. Wrap round reporting can be activated with line by line override of  
the oldest data.  
# OF PAID RECALL TRANSACTIONS  
It is possible the display the last transactions and issue copy receipts. This is the maximum number for recall.  
# OF KEYSTROKES IN SUPER MACRO  
This is not related to the normal macro functions keys of which there are 40 with 50 keystrokes This is the  
number of keystrokes which can be stored in the terminals log file before wrap round reporting begins.  
STORE BITMAP  
This provides an area for receiving and printing a PC designed graphic logo. Bmp file  
ANALYSIS1 BY TIME PERIODS  
This allows analysis of a sale within a specific area, the sale total is stored under the analysis heading for  
reporting on the financial and appropriate time period report. The default text can be changed allowing  
monitoring of any area / category / department, The analysis keys can also be used to change the printer output  
for product orders.  
MEMORY ALLOCATION - DEFINITIONS  
49  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ANALYSIS2 BY TIME PERIODS  
This allows analysis of a sale within a specific area, the sale total is stored under the analysis heading for  
reporting on the financial and appropriate time period report. The default text can be changed allowing  
monitoring of any area / category / department, The analysis keys can also be used to change the printer output  
for product orders.  
ANALYSIS3 BY TIME PERIODS  
This allows analysis of a sale within a specific area, the sale total is stored under the analysis heading for  
reporting on the financial and appropriate time period report. The default text can be changed allowing  
monitoring of any area / category / department, The analysis keys can also be used to change the printer output  
for product orders.  
TRACK 1 – 4 BY TIME PERIODS  
This provides analysis of the closed/paid check tracking totals with the total monies received reported per hour.  
CLERK INTERRUPT  
This enables the layaway of active sales enabling more than one operator to use the terminal at a time  
# OF MIX & MATCH TABLE  
These are the discount tables that are available for allocation to products for automatic sales discount .  
REPORT SELECTION TABLE  
This enables activation five reporting areas. Each of the five report areas can be read and reset independently.  
50  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
51  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                   
                                                                   
SELF TESTS  
The following procedures are used to perform diagnostic tests on the terminal. The integrity  
of peripherals are tested at this stage.  
S-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. SELF TESTS  
2. MEMORY CLEAR  
3. MEMORY ALLOCATION DISPLAY  
4. KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
5. SYSTEM OPTIONS  
6. PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
7. SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
8. DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
9. S-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
10. SYSTEM PASSWORD  
11. SUPER MACRO SCAN  
12. ROM FILE DOWNLOAD  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
01 16:32:43  
H/W TEST  
1999.11.12 FRI  
1. SERIAL & IRC LOOPBACK  
2. DRAWER  
3. RTC SETTING  
4. DISPLAY  
5. KEYBOARD  
6. MODE & CLERK KEY  
7. RAM  
8. IRC  
9. PRINTER  
10. RAM CHECKSUM  
11. VERSION CHECK  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
52  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SELF TESTS - DEFINITIONS  
SERIAL & IRC LOOP BACK  
This is a diagnostics test for the serial port. Special Loop back connections are required.  
DRAWER  
This will test the opening of the cash drawers, there are 3 drawers available  
RTC SETTING  
This is the real time clock setting for the service mode.  
DISPLAY  
This will test the integrity of the display, and all display segments. The display can also be programmed with a  
screen saver so that the display switches to stand by after a number of minutes.  
KEYBOARD  
This will enable you to test any function key switch on the keyboard  
MODE & CLERK KEY  
This will test all mode lock positions and the clerk lock functions  
RAM  
This will test both reading and writing of the Random access memory  
IRC  
This will test the Ethernet inter register communication, helping to determine that all terminals are connected.  
Register # Setting  
– This re-programs the terminal’s register number  
– This tests the integrity of the internal loop back chip  
– This tests the terminals drivers  
Internal Loop Back(Chip)  
Internal Loop Back(Driver)  
External Loop Back  
– This tests the loop back communications externally.  
IRC System Test  
– This tests the Inter Register communications network and is useful  
PRINTER  
This will test any device connected to each of the seven output ports  
RAM CHECKSUM  
This will read and verify the Random access memory chips. (No data is affected when this procedure is run.)  
VERSION CHECK  
This will check and display the current operating version and available the number of products used out of the  
maximum number available, also showing the number of program initialisations preformed also the number of  
power failures on the terminal.  
53  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                   
                                                                   
                          
                          
                                                                                                                 
                                                                                                                 
MEMORY CLEAR  
This provides a way of resetting a sales activity back to zero without carrying out reset reports, also the ability to  
reset site unique date such as PLUs etc..  
NOTE Option 14 will reset/remove all programmed saleable items from the system completely and is not  
referring to PLU sales data.  
S-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. SELF TESTS  
2. MEMORY CLEAR  
3. MEMORY ALLOCATION DISPLAY  
4. KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
5. SYSTEM OPTIONS  
6. PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
7. SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
8. DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
9. S-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
10. SYSTEM PASSWORD  
11. SUPER MACRO SCAN  
12. ROM FILE DOWNLOAD  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
S-MODE MEMORY CLEAR  
L1  
S-MODE MEMORY CLEAR  
L1  
1. RESET ALL TTLS, CNTS & GRAND TTLS  
2. CLEAR TOTALS AND COUNTERS  
3. CLEAR GRAND TOTALS ONLY  
4. CLEAR ORDER TRACKING #1  
5. CLEAR ORDER TRACKING #2  
6. CLEAR ORDER TRACKING #3  
7. CLEAR ORDER TRACKING #4  
8. CLEAR PAID ORDER RECALL  
9. CLEAR PRODUCT PROJECTIONS  
10. CLEAR TIME-KEEPING  
8. CLEAR PAID ORDER RECALL  
9. CLEAR PRODUCT PROJECTIONS  
10. CLEAR TIME-KEEPING  
11. CLEAR CLERK INTERRUPT  
12. CLEAR LOGO BITMAP IMAGE  
13. CLEAR PRE-POLL STATUS FLAG  
14. CLEAR PLU FILE  
15. CLEAR SUPER MACRO  
16. CLEAR ELECTRONIC JOURNAL  
17. CLEAR INITIAL&POWER FAIL COUNTER  
18. CLEAR CONSECUTIVE#  
19. CLEAR ALL (1-11)  
11. CLEAR CLERK INTERRUPT  
12. CLEAR LOGO BITMAP IMAGE  
!
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
%
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
54  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MEMORY CLEAR - DEFINITIONS  
RESET ALL TTLS, CNTS & GRAND TTLS  
This will remove any sales from the reporting memory, clearing all totals, including grand totals  
CLEAR TOTALS AND COUNTERS  
This will remove any sales from the terminals reporting memory, clearing all totals and counters. It will however  
leave the running grand totals in the system.  
CLEAR ORDER TRACKING#1 - 4  
This will clear the open check, setting the balance to zero. The sales are still retained for that check on the  
financial and product reports. This must be carried out on the terminal set by S-mode system options to store the  
check data.  
CLEAR PAID ORDER RECALL  
This is reset the memory for displaying paid transactions, the information will begin storing again  
CLEAR PRODUCT PROJECTIONS  
This will reset any information held in the product mix, sales projection files, which store the product  
usage, period projection analysis  
CLEAR TIME-KEEPING  
This will reset any employee time clock information, remove all hours worked totalisers and labour costing  
CLEAR CLERK INTERRUPT  
This will remove any sales currently open against an employee  
CLEAR LOGO BITMAP IMAGE  
This will remove from memory the computer download logo image file.  
CLEAR PRE-POLL STATUS FLAG  
If an unsuccessful attempt has been made to consolidate terminals sales data. The report is flagged as failed. This  
will remove that flag allowing normal reporting consolidation again.  
CLEAR PLU FILE  
This will completely remove the product file and any related data, ensure that any outstanding checks etc have  
also been cleared as they too will contain product data.  
CLEAR SUPER MACRO  
This will clear the terminals keystroke operation log file.  
CLEAR ELECTRONIC JOURNAL  
This will reset all sales data held within the electronic journal without printing. This can also be reset without  
printing in the Z mode position.  
CLEAR INITIAL&POWER FAIL COUNTER  
This will reset the counters on the self-test version check, which record the program initalisation and power  
failures  
55  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                          
                          
                                                                                                  
                                                                                                  
KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
Each one of the five keyboards can be programmed completely independently of the other.  
Note: the following Essential Function Keys must be on each keyboard  
Numeric Keys 0-9  
CL/ESC  
YES/NO  
Cursor Control Keys UP/DOWN/LEFT/RIGHT  
PAGE UP/PAGE DOWN  
ENTER  
DONE  
X/TIME  
S-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
L1  
1. SELF TESTS  
1. PLU KEYS  
2. MEMORY CLEAR  
2. WLU KEYS  
3. MEMORY ALLOCATION DISPLAY  
4. KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
5. SYSTEM OPTIONS  
3. FUNCTION KEYS  
6. PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
7. SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
8. DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
9. S-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
10. SYSTEM PASSWORD  
1. KEYBOARD LEVEL 1  
2. KEYBOARD LEVEL 2  
3. KEYBOARD LEVEL 3  
4. KEYBOARD LEVEL 4  
5 KEYBOARD
 
LEVEL 5  
11. SUPER MACRO SCAN  
12. ROM FILE DOWNLOAD  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
FUNCTION KEY RELOCATION PROGRAMMING  
KEYBOARD LEVEL 1  
L1  
FUNCTION KEY RELOCATION PROGRAMMING  
L1  
KEYBOARD LEVEL : 1  
CURRENT ASSIGNMENT :  
KEY POSITION : 105  
PRESS ANY KEY TO READ AND/OR CHANGE  
CURRENT ASSIGNMENT  
013 ADD CHECK  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
NUMERIC 1  
NUMERIC 2  
NUMERIC 3  
NUMERIC 4  
NUMERIC 5  
NUMERIC 6  
NUMERIC 7  
8
9
NUMERIC 8  
NUMERIC 9  
OR  
10 NUMERIC 0  
11 NUMERIC 00  
12 NUMERIC 000  
13 ADD CHECK  
14 BACK SPACE  
PRESS ESC TO EXIT  
!
56  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION - DEFINITIONS  
PLU KEYS  
This allocates PLU product number keys to the keyboard. This will provided touch of the  
button entry for selling products. There are a maximum of five keyboards available each of  
which can have either the same product information or completely different product codes.  
WLU KEYS (WINDOW LOOK UPS)  
This allocates Window Look Up numbers to keys to the keyboard. This will provided touch of  
the button menu selection, These menu windows can contain products, function key list, or  
condiment instructions or a combination of any of those. Each of the five levels can have  
either the same product information completely different product codes, or even a mix of  
each.  
FUNCTION KEYS  
This is the main programming section as it determines the operation of each key  
(Be aware of the required function keys shown at the beginning of this keyboard allocation section)  
NOTE: If the keyboards are to be the same or similar it is possible to use the  
program mode ‘Copy Program’ Option this will save time by copying a programmed  
keyboard from one level to another.  
57  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY – LISTING  
CODE  
1
NAME  
CODE  
70  
71  
72  
73  
74  
75  
76  
77  
78  
79  
80  
81  
82  
83  
84  
85  
86  
87  
88  
89  
90  
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
NAME  
CODE  
139  
140  
141  
142  
143  
144  
145  
146  
147  
148  
149  
150  
151  
152  
153  
154  
155  
156  
157  
158  
159  
160  
161  
162  
163  
164  
NAME  
NUMERIC 1  
NUMERIC 2  
NUMERIC 3  
NUMERIC 4  
NUMERIC 5  
NUMERIC 6  
NUMERIC 7  
NUMERIC 8  
NUMERIC 9  
NUMERIC 0  
NUMERIC 00  
NUMERIC 000  
ADD CHECK  
BACKSPACE  
BOLD  
MACRO PAUSE  
MACRO R (REG)  
MACRO S (S-MODE)  
MACRO SET (RECORD)  
MACRO VOID  
MACRO X  
MODIFIER4  
MODIFIER5  
MODIFIER6  
MODIFIER7  
MODIFIER8  
MODIFIER9  
MODIFIER10  
NEXT RECORD  
#/NOSALE  
P/BAL  
2
3
4
5
6
7
MACRO Z  
8
MACRO1  
9
MACRO2  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
MACRO3  
MACRO4  
PAGE DOWN  
PAGE UP  
PAID OUT1  
PAID OUT2  
PAID OUT3  
PAID OUT4  
PAID OUT5  
PAID RECALL  
% 1  
MACRO5  
MACRO6  
MACRO7  
MACRO8  
CANCEL  
MACRO9  
CAPS  
MACRO10  
MACRO11  
MACRO12  
MACRO13  
MACRO14  
MACRO15  
MACRO16  
MACRO17  
MACRO18  
MACRO19  
CASH  
TIP DECLARE  
SLIP  
% 2  
CHEQUE  
% 3  
CHEQUE CASH  
CHK ENDORSE  
CLEAR  
% 4  
% 5  
% 6  
CONTINUE  
% 7  
CURR CONV 1  
EURO  
% 8  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
CURR CONV 2  
CURR CONV 3  
CURR CONV 4  
CURR CONV 5  
CUR DOWN  
96  
97  
MACRO20  
MACRO21  
MACRO22  
MACRO23  
MACRO24  
MACRO25  
MACRO26  
165  
166  
167  
168  
169  
170  
171  
% 9  
% 10  
98  
PLU  
99  
PREV.RECORD  
PRICE INQ  
PRICE LVL1  
PRICE LVL2  
100  
101  
102  
CUR LEFT  
CUR RIGHT  
58  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY – LISTING  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
51  
52  
53  
54  
55  
56  
57  
58  
59  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
65  
66  
67  
CUR UP  
103  
104  
105  
106  
107  
108  
109  
110  
111  
112  
113  
114  
115  
116  
117  
118  
119  
120  
121  
122  
123  
124  
125  
126  
127  
128  
129  
130  
131  
132  
133  
134  
135  
136  
MACRO27  
172  
173  
174  
175  
176  
177  
178  
179  
180  
181  
182  
183  
184  
185  
186  
187  
188  
189  
190  
191  
192  
193  
194  
195  
196  
197  
198  
199  
200  
201  
202  
203  
204  
205  
PRICE LVL3  
PRICE LVL4  
PRICE LVL5  
PRICE LVL6  
PRICE LVL7  
PRICE LVL8  
PRICE LVL9  
PRICE LVL10  
PRICE LVL11  
PRICE LVL12  
PRICE LVL13  
PRICE LVL14  
PRICE LVL15  
PRICE LVL16  
PRICE LVL17  
PRICE LVL18  
PRICE LVL19  
PRICE LVL20  
PRINT  
DECIMAL  
MACRO28  
DELETE  
MACRO29  
DONE  
MACRO30  
ANALYSIS3  
ANALYSIS1  
EMPLOYEE  
EMPLOYEE1  
EMPLOYEE2  
EMPLOYEE3  
EMPLOYEE4  
EMPLOYEE5  
EMPLOYEE6  
EMPLOYEE7  
EMPLOYEE8  
EMPLOYEE9  
EMPLOYEE10  
ENTER  
MACRO31  
MACRO32  
MACRO33  
MACRO34  
MACRO35  
MACRO36  
MACRO37  
MACRO38  
MACRO39  
MACRO40  
MACRO # (CODE NO.)  
MDSE RETURN  
MISC TEND1  
MISC TEND2  
MISC TEND3  
MISC TEND4  
MISC TEND5  
MISC TEND6  
MISC TEND7  
MISC TEND8  
MISC TEND9  
MISC TEND10  
MISC TEND11  
MISC TEND12  
MISC TEND13  
MISC TEND14  
MISC TEND15  
MISC TEND16  
MISC TEND#  
MODIFIER1  
ERR.CORR.  
FD/S SHIFT  
FD/S SUBTL  
FD/S TEND  
GUEST #  
PRINT CHECK  
PRINT HOLD  
PROMO  
PRT SCREEN  
QUIT  
HOLD  
INACTIVE  
RCPT ON/OFF  
RECALL CHK1  
RECALL CHK2  
RECALL CHK3  
RECALL CHK4  
RECD ACCT1  
RECD ACCT2  
RECD ACCT3  
RECD ACCT4  
RECD ACCT5  
KEYBD LVL1  
KEYBD LVL2  
KEYBD LVL3  
KEYBD LVL4  
KEYBD LVL5  
LIST CHECK1  
LIST CHECK2  
LIST CHECK3  
LIST CHECK4  
59  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY – LISTING  
68  
MACRO OFF  
MACRO P  
137  
138  
231  
232  
233  
234  
235  
236  
237  
238  
239  
240  
241  
242  
243  
244  
245  
246  
247  
248  
249  
250  
251  
252  
253  
MODIFIER2  
MODIFIER3  
TIME IN/OUT (CLOCK IN/OUT)  
TIP1  
206  
207  
254  
255  
RECEIPT  
69  
REPEAT  
208  
209  
210  
211  
212  
213  
214  
215  
216  
217  
218  
219  
220  
221  
222  
223  
224  
225  
226  
227  
228  
229  
230  
SCALE  
NOFOUND PLU  
PRICE CHG  
SEAT #  
SHIFT  
TIP2  
SPLIT ITEM  
SPLIT PAY  
STOCK INQ  
STORE CHK1  
STORE CHK2  
STORE CHK3  
STORE CHK4  
SUBTOTAL  
TABLE 1  
TIP3  
TRANS CHK1  
TRANS CHK2  
TRANS CHK3  
TRANS CHK4  
TRAY SUBTL (TICKET ISSUE)  
VALID  
VOID ITEM  
WASTE  
TABLE 2  
WLU  
TABLE 3  
X/TIME  
TABLE 4  
YES/NO  
ANALYSIS2  
TAX EXEMPT  
TAX SHIFT1  
TAX SHIFT2  
TAX SHIFT3  
TAX SHIFT4  
TAX SHIFT5  
TAX SHIFT6  
PARK ORDER  
SERVE ORDER  
KP ROUTING  
SPLIT CHECK  
NEW CHECK1  
NEW CHECK2  
NEW CHECK3  
NEW CHECK4  
60  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
NUMERIC 1  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 2  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 3  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 4  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 5  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 6  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 7  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 8  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 9  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 00  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 000  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
ADD CHECK  
Used to add multiple guest checks (soft checks) for payment together or to add check between different tracking  
files. or to move one check to another.  
BACK SPACE  
Used to program the alpha programming BACKSPACE function key  
61  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
BOLD  
Used to program the alpha programming BOLD function key  
CANCEL  
Press the cancel to abort a transaction in progress. All current items are removed (voided)  
CAPS  
Used to reposition the alpha programming CAPTIAL Letters lock function key  
CASH  
Used to finalise or tender cash sales. Change is computed when the amount of the cash tender is greater than the  
amount of the sale. There is also the programmable option of allowing change to be calculated once a sale has  
been completed using the post tender system flag.  
TIP DECLARE  
This is used for the declaration of tips earnt by employees  
SLIP  
Used to print guest check bills to a loose-leaf paper printer  
CHEQUE  
Use the cheque key to finalise or tender cheque sales. Change is computed when the amount of the cheque tender  
is greater than the amount of the sale. This can be used as a cash back feature for cheque payments.  
CHEQUE CASH  
Use the Check Cashing key to exchange a cheque for cash outside of a sale.  
CHECK ENDORSEMENT  
This will print onto the check an endorsement message (only on printer models with a validation sensor)  
CLEAR  
Press CLEAR to clear numeric entries or error conditions  
CONTINUE  
Used in-conjunction with the magnetic card swipe system  
CURR CONV 1 - 5  
Used to convert and display the value of the transaction in foreign currency. This works also for Euro dual  
pricing in-conjunction with system printing flags. It is assumed currency rate one is the Euro exchange rate  
62  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
CURSOR DOWN  
Use the cursor control keys to relocate the position of the cursor on the screen  
CURSOR LEFT  
Use the cursor control keys to relocate the position of the cursor on the screen  
CURSOR RIGHT  
Use the cursor control keys to relocate the position of the cursor on the screen  
CURSOR UP  
Use the cursor control keys to relocate the position of the cursor on the screen  
DECIMAL  
Use the decimal key to enter fractional rates or percentages. Do not use to enter amounts. The decimal is  
automatically inserted in the correct position.  
DELETE  
Used to program the alpha programming DELETE function key.  
DONE  
Press DONE to exit a WLU screen when multiple entries are allowed on the WLU. This key is required for  
programming and should not be omitted from the keyboard. This key also acts as a backspace when programming  
alpha.  
ANALYSIS 3  
This key is used to record sales totals providing analysis on the both the financial report and special hourly sales  
analysis report. The default text can be changed providing sales analysis for any category. This key can also be  
programmed to switch the printing area of kitchen orders.  
ANALYSIS 1  
This key is used to record sales totals providing analysis on the both the financial report and special hourly sales  
analysis report. The default text can be changed providing sales analysis for any category. This key can also be  
programmed to switch the printing area of kitchen orders.  
EMPLOYEE # (CASHIER)  
The employee number key is used to sign on the cashier, clerk, server or employee who is starting registration.  
This key is used for CLERK CODE entry.  
EMPLOYEE 1- 10  
The employee keys 1 – 10 can be programmed to sign on a specific cashier when pressed directly without  
entering a code. These keys are used for PUSH Button clerk entry  
63  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
ENTER  
When programming press the ENTER key to place data into a field with the cursor remaining in the field.  
ERR CORRECT  
Press the error correct key to remove an item from the sale total. This also acts as delete when programming  
WLUs  
FD STAMP SHIFT  
Press FD STAMP SHIFT to shift the pre-programmed food stamp voucher status of an item prior to its  
registration.  
FD STAMP SUBTTL  
Press FD STMP SUBTTL to display the total of food stamp voucher eligible items registered in the current  
transaction.  
FD STAMP TENDER  
Use the FD STMP TENDER key to tender Food Stamp vouchers after the display of the food stamp eligible  
subtotal. Depending upon function key programming, change less than £1 can be applied to any cash balance or  
issued as cash change.  
GUEST #  
Used to record the number of guests served by a transaction. The entry may be compulsory, the entry can also be  
programmed to appear on printers  
HOLD  
Used to identify an individual item, or an entire transaction, in order that the selected items will not print/display  
on the kitchen printer / KVS when the transaction is finalised. The system can be programmed to warn if items  
are held when a check is stored, also to automatic select ready for print when a check is recalled.  
INACTIVE  
The inactive function key can be re-used as many times as necessary to inactivate key locations  
KEYBOARD LEVEL 1 - 5  
Use to select one of the five keyboard levels. Keyboard levels can be changed manually using these keys or  
automated to change at a pre-programmed time on a pre-programmed day. They can also be changed in X-mode.  
LIST CHECK 1 - 4  
Press the List Check key to display a list of open checks.  
64  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
MACRO OFF  
This switches the macro during the pre-programmed key sequence to the Off position. This key is not required on  
the keyboard as it is accessed during macro programming  
MACRO P  
This switches the macro during the pre-programmed key sequence to the P-MODE position. This key is not  
required on the keyboard as it is accessed during macro programming  
MACRO PAUSE  
Used to indicate a pause in the macro, allowing greater user choice for the display and operation of macros one  
pause is programmed per required key press.  
MACRO R  
This switches the macro during the pre-programmed key sequence to the Register mode position. This key is not  
required on the keyboard an is accessed during macro programming  
MACRO S  
This switches the macro during the pre-programmed key sequence to the S-mode position. This key is not  
required on the keyboard as it is accessed during macro programming  
MACRO SET  
This key is used in REG as a method of programming macros by recording the key-strokes as they are entered.  
By pressing the MACRO SET key carrying out the require mode changes, key-strokes etc then pressing the  
MACRO1-40 key to finalise the sequences to that key.  
MACRO VOID  
This switches the macro during the pre-programmed key sequence to the Void-mode position. This key is not  
required on the keyboard as it is accessed during macro programming  
MACRO X  
This switches the macro during the pre-programmed key sequence to the X-mode position. This key is not  
required on the keyboard as it is accessed during macro programming  
MACRO Z  
This switches the macro during the pre-programmed key sequence to the Z-mode position. This key is not  
required on the keyboard as it is accessed during macro programming  
MACRO 1 - 40  
Used to execute one of the forty possible pre-programmed key sequences, by allocating the required key and then  
programming the appropriate sequence. Macros can be included in a Window  
MACRO #  
65  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Used to execute one of forty possible macros by entering the macro number and pressing the macro code entry  
key  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
MDSE RETURN  
Used to remove items from the sales totals and return goods back into stock. This key can be used within or  
outside of a transaction  
MISC TEND 1 - 16  
Use a MISC TEND key to finalise or tender sales paid by various charges or other media. Tendering may or may  
not be allowed depending upon programming  
MISC TEND #  
Used to access by code any one of the 16 MISC TEND keys used to finalise or tender sales paid by various  
charges or other media. Tendering may or may not be allowed depending upon programming  
MODIFIER 1 - 10  
Preceding a PLU entry a modifier key changes one digit of the PLU number, causing a different PLU to be  
registered. MODIFIER Keys can be set to change either the item code or the description only. This can be used  
to be build up a code number system with various modifiers working together to sell a complied code. For  
example if MODIFIER 1 is set to change the 4th digit of the PLU by 4 and MODIFIER 2 is set to change the 3rd  
digit by 5 pressing MODIFIER 1 then MODIFIER 2 followed by PLU 1 would sell code 4501 PLU 2 would  
become 4502 etc..  
NEXT RECORD  
Used to program the next record key, which is used during programming to move through the program  
records.  
#/NOSALE  
Used to enter a non-adding memo number during a transaction (# function) or used to open the cash drawer  
outside of a sale  
P/BAL  
Enter an amount, then press the manual previous balance (P/bal) key to use the simplest form of Charge Posting /  
Table Service.  
PAGE DOWN  
This key switches between pages on the register display. Used in Window Look-Ups etc.  
PAGE UP  
This key switches between pages on the register display. Used in Window Look-Ups etc.  
66  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PAID OUT 1 - 5  
Press a Paid Out key to register monies removed from the cash drawer  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
PAID RECALL  
The paid recall key is used to recall the last xx number of transactions, where xx is defined in the memory.  
Pressing RECEIPT ISSUE key whilst a transaction is displayed will result in a copy receipt for the sale, being  
printed.  
%1 - %10  
Ten discount/Premium keys are available to handle various types of discounts, mark downs and adjustments to  
items or transactions.  
PLU  
Used to register a PLU by entering the appropriate PLU number and pressing the PLU/# key  
PREVIOUS RECORD  
This key is used to switch to the previous PLU entered.  
PRICE INQUIRY  
Used to inquire on the retail price of a product this can be programmed to display for a single item or multiple  
products  
PRICE LEVEL 1 - 20  
Press a price level key prior to a PLU entry to shift the price of a PLU to a different ‘price set’ pre-programmed  
to the PLU. Each product has the ability to sell at five different prices. The prices are not fixed however at price  
levels 1 through to five. The Price level can be allocated from any of the twenty to provide detailed price  
reporting using the PLU by price level report (if set in memory allocation). The norm for a bar is two prices  
normal and special offer price this requires no special programming. The terminal however can be programmed  
to used up to twenty price bands. For example we could have some PLUs using prices 1 – 5 representing sizes  
and some PLUs using prices 6 – 10. This would then representing different products types sold at different sizes;  
pressing the appropriate price key will sell the correct size. Then using the price level report, the analysis would  
show the total per product a breakdown of the price sales per product and overall sales total for all products per  
price level  
PRINT  
This key is used to temporarily change the remote printer settings of a PLU allowing printing to the programmed  
printer route allocated to this key. It is required that a product to priny has KP Print set to Y to allow the item to  
be printed.  
PRINT CHECK  
Used during any open check or after finalisation to print a detailed bill for check tracking files 1 – 4, The bill can  
if required be programed to proint automatically to the printer defined by this key.  
67  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PRINT HOLD  
Used to remove the HOLD designation from an item or order, so that the items and their instructions are now sent  
to the kitchen printer/KVS at finalisation  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
PROMO  
Press the PROMO key to void the price (the item remains). This can be used in 2 for 1 promotions etc.  
A promo count and value of discount given is shown on the financial reports.  
PRINT SCREEN  
Press the print screen key to print a copy of the current screen on the designated receipt printer  
QUIT  
Press QUIT to automatically sign on/off the current cashier/clerk, when using the magnetic card swipe.  
RECEIPT ON /OFF  
This is used to turn the receipt off, The receipt can be programmed using system flags to be a continuous receipt  
with the ability to issue a post receipt (default setting) or to print only when the post receipt key is pressed.  
RECALL CHECK 1 - 4  
The Check Tracking System can Maintain only balances (hard checks) or entire transactions (soft checks) in the  
register memory. Four different tracking files can be separated to maintain different information eg bar tabs,  
tables etc. The check number can be entered by the employee or be programmed to be an automatically generate  
a number.  
RECD ACCT 1 - 5  
Press a RECD ACCT key to register monies added to cash, check or miscellaneous media to the drawer  
RECEIPT ISSUE  
Press this key to issue a copy receipt. This key can also be used with PAID RECALL to issue receipts of past  
sales.  
REPEAT  
Use the repeat key to quickly re-order a set of items, for a check tracking sale. This key repeats the last check  
order which has previously been stored.  
SCALE  
Use the scale key to automatically display the weight from a scale connected to the register, or to manually enter  
a weight for extension.  
68  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
SEAT#  
Used to identify a specific seat (or person) within a transaction. Facilitates separate payment by seat from a single  
check and identifies to the food preparation staff how to assemble meals. This feature also provides separate  
billing  
To allocate items to a seat enter the seat number and press the seat key prior to selling the product or scroll  
through the items on the display and allocate by pressing the seat key followed by the seat number then the seat  
key again to accept. Payment is accepted by pressing subtotal then the seat key to display and pay the balances  
due.  
SHIFT  
Used to program the alpha programming Shift capital letters lock function key  
SPLIT ITEM  
When like items are consolidated in a transaction. You can move the cursor to the item and press the SPLIT  
ITEM key to display the items separately, instead of in consolidated form, used normally to assist the items to  
seat allocation.  
SPLIT PAYMENT  
Use the split payment key to divide the amount of a guest check into equal segments for payment and issue bills  
accordingly. To pay bills using the split payment method, recall the guest check press the sutotal key then enter  
the numer of people by which the bill is to be split then press the split payment key to activate the display of  
balances due for payment for each person.  
STOCK INQUIRY  
Used to display the current stock situation for a PLU, this will display the total stock for all the registers in the  
system. This can be programmed to display stock for one item then return to register mode or display stock for  
each product pressed until clear is used to exit.  
STORE CHECK 1 - 4  
The check tracking system can maintain only balances (hard check) or entire transactions (soft check) in the  
register memory. Four different tracking files can be separately maintained. The system can allow the operator to  
enter the check number manually using the RECALL CHECK key or to automatically generate a check number.  
SUBTOTAL  
Used to display the balance due. This can be programmed to print on request  
TABLE 1 - 4  
This is used for reference as to which table a check is related to, there can be numerous checks per table,  
depending upon, programming of the store check key. There is also the feature that checks can be recalled using  
the table number, if the table applies to more than one check all relevant checks will be displayed in a selection  
window.  
69  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
ANLAYSIS 2  
This key is used to record sales totals providing analysis on the both the financial report and special hourly sales,  
analysis reports. The default text can be changed providing sales analysis for any category. This key can also be  
used to change the print location of a kitchen order.  
TAX EXEMPT  
The Tax Exempt can be programmed to exempt specific taxes from a sale.  
TAX SHIFT 1 - 6  
These are used to change temporarily the pre-programmed tax rate of a product.  
TIME IN/OUT (CLOCK IN/OUT)  
Enter the employee clock in code then press the key to record start and end work times, breaks etc. Hours are  
maintained by the time clock system. There are various analysis reports for labour costing analysis to assist with  
management of this feature.  
TIP 1 - 3  
Used to enter a tip amount on a check tracking bill, the tip keys can be programed as either and percent or  
amount.  
TRANSFER CHECK 1 - 4  
Used to transfer check monies/open checks from one employee to another. This key is not used for check  
numbers.  
TRAY SUBTOTAL (TICKET ISSUE)  
This key provides excellent flexibility of receipt issuance. The sale is entered as normal in register when a receipt  
is required this key is pressed and a receipt for all items sold to that point is issued.  
VALIDATE  
Use this key to initiate a single line validation (a printer with validation capability must be connected)  
VOID ITEM  
This key is used to remove an item from a transaction. Locate the cursor on the item press the VOID key.  
WASTE  
This is used to start and end entries of items that are wasted. A waste count is maintained for each item and the  
inventory is adjusted, counters and values are provided on the financial reports.  
WLU #  
Used to access windows look up menus by their code number or to allocated a WLU one touch button to the  
keyboard  
70  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
X/TIME  
Used for multiplication and split pricing entries in the register position.  
PARK ORDER/SERVE ORDER  
Used with the kitchen video system to control order service  
KP ROUTING  
The system stores four periods of order printing sequences for example during the day the bar printer may print  
both food and drinks items whilst in the evening the bar prints drinks only and the restaurant printer issues food  
orders. This can be changed automatically using time periods or manually using this key.  
NEW CHECK 1 – 4  
The standard recall check key allows a check to be opened if it does not already exist. This is excellent in  
hospitality tracking, however for account management credit may not so readily be given. Therefore when this  
button is programmed accounts are not opened automatically. A warning will indicate an account does not exist if  
an attempt is made to open using the recall check key. The new check button is used to open new accounts. The  
programmability for this key is automatically picked up from the status of the Recall check key.  
NOFOUND PLU (NOT FOUND PLU)  
If a code is entered or scanned that does not exist It is then possible using this key to create that item.  
PRICE CHANGE  
This allows the pre-programmed price of an item to be changed. There are optionally programmed restrictions  
71  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
72  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                                                                   
                                                                                                                   
↑↓  
                          
                          
                                                                                                                   
                                                                                                                   
S-MODE SYSTEM OPTIONS  
This section is used to define the most fundamental parameters of the whole system such  
as, how many machines are in the network, which machine number will store common data  
etc.  
S-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
S-MODE SYSTEM OPTIONS  
L1  
01  
000000  
01  
1. SELF TESTS  
2. MEMORY CLEAR  
1. REGISTER # (01 – 32)  
2. STORE #  
3. IRC : FROM REGISTER #  
4. IRC : TO REGISTER #  
5. IRC # OF RETRIES  
6. PRINT/DISPLAY DECIMAL POSITION  
7. SEND PLU DESCRIPTOR WHEN POLLED Y  
3. MEMORY ALLOCATION DISPLAY  
4. KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
5. SYSTEM OPTIONS  
6. PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
7. SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
8. DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
9. S-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
10. SYSTEM PASSWORD  
01  
00  
2•  
8. PASSWORD (0000=NO PASSWRD): X =0000  
Z1=0000  
Z2=0000  
Z3=0000  
Z4=0000  
Z5=0000  
11. SUPER MACRO SCAN  
12. ROM FILE DOWNLOAD  
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
S-MODE SYSTEM OPTIONS  
L1  
01  
S-MODE SYSTEM OPTIONS  
L1  
9. REG HOLDS TIME IN/OUT DATA  
14. ROM FILE DOWNLOAD PASSWORD 9999  
10. REG# HOLDS CHECK TRACKING DATA  
(0000=NO PASSWORD)  
CHECK#1  
CHECK#2  
CHECK#3  
CHECK#4  
01  
01  
01  
01  
11. REG# HOLDS BACKUP CHECK TRACK DATA  
CHECK#1  
CHECK#2  
CHECK#3  
CHECK#4  
02  
02  
02  
02  
12. REG# HOLDS KP GLOBAL ORDER#  
01  
13. REG# HOLDS CLERK INTERRUPT DATA 01  
%
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
"
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
73  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
S-MODE SYSTEM OPTIONS – DEFINITIONS  
REGISTER # (1-32)  
This is the register number for this terminal. This is required to be a sequential number starting from 1 (the  
master) then in turn for each of the terminals in an inter-register communications system.  
STORE #  
This is used during communications to indicate which store sales are collected from. Defaults to 0s  
IRC : FROM REGISTER  
This is the number of the first terminal in an inter-register communications system. The norm is 1  
IRC : TO REGISTER  
This is the number for the last terminal in an inter-register communications system.  
IRC # OF RETRIES  
The standard setting will be acceptable here, unless a specialist environment is to be designed. This feature  
controls the number of requests to consolidate a terminal before failure is announced.  
PRINT/DISPLAY DECIMAL POSITION  
This is the number of decimal places the system will use. It is assumed in the UK to be 2 decimals  
SEND PLU DESCRIPTOR WHEN POLLED  
This will send in addition to the normal information, the PLU description, when polled by a P.C.  
PASSWORD (0000 = NO PASSWORD)  
Each of the reporting areas can be password protected provided management restriction  
REG# HOLDS TIME IN/OUT DATA  
The time clock, labour hours worked and costing analysis feature can be operated on any terminal however the  
data is held centrally on one cash register.  
REG# HOLDS CHECK TRACKING DATA  
The four check tracking billing files can be operated on any terminal. The files however are stored centrally,  
normally on terminal 1 (the master). On a more tailored system this can be changed so that each tracking file is  
stored on a different terminal, the information will be available for central use.  
REG# HOLDS KP GLOBAL ORDER#  
The order number printed on kitchen order tickets can be the register number followed by a consecutive number  
of can be held centrally and be a system consecutive number this is refered to as a global order number.  
ROM FILE DOWNLOAD PASSWORD  
The flash ROM can be transmitted across the network using a S-mode option this is the password  
74  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                      
                                                                      
↑↓  
                                                                      
                                                                      
↑↓  
PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
This is used to customise existing printer formats or to add generic printers to the system.  
There is normally no need to change this information. The only exception being, printing  
bitmap images where the initialisation code should be deleted for the appropriate printer.  
S-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. SELF TESTS  
2. MEMORY CLEAR  
3. MEMORY ALLOCATION DISPLAY  
4. KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
5. SYSTEM OPTIONS  
6. PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
7. SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
8. DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
9. S-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
10. SYSTEM PASSWORD  
11. SUPER MACRO SCAN  
12. ROM FILE DOWNLOAD  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
L1  
CANCEL  
PRINTER TYPE  
START  
SAM SRP-100  
SAM SRP-250  
SAM SRP-300  
CITIZEN 3541  
CITIZEN 810  
CITIZEN 230  
EPSON T88-2  
EPSON U200  
EPSON U295  
EPSON U300  
EPSON U325  
INITIALIZE  
COMPRESSED  
RED/REV  
EXPANDED  
BOLD  
UNDERLINE  
LONG FEED  
FULL CUT  
PART. CUT  
STANDARD  
LOGO  
1B40  
1B2121  
1B2101  
1B64  
1B69  
1B69  
!
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
75  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PRINTER DRIVER DEFINITIONS  
PRINTER TYPE  
Common printer types have been defined, SAMSUNG, CITIZEN, EPSON etc, These need no modification. The  
system does have some custom printer types available for technicians to allocate their own settings.  
PRINTER TASK, INTIALISE COMPRESS  
This is the definition area of the tasks the printer can perform such as bold, underline etc. This is a fixed field and  
is used to label the start and cancel codes. The only amendment that need be made is when a bitmap graphics  
image is to be printed and then, the initialisation code would be deleted on the appropriate printer, or an  
alternatively is when a generic printer is to be allocated to the system.  
START CODE  
This code relates to the Printer task and is input from your own printer manual when defining a custom printer.  
END CODE  
This code relates to the Printer task and is input from your own printer manual when defining a custom printer.  
76  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                   
                                                                   
SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
The serial ports are the physical connections on the terminal, three as standard with a  
maximum of seven available. The following section defines which type of peripheral will be  
attached to the port  
S-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. SELF TESTS  
2. MEMORY CLEAR  
3. MEMORY ALLOCATION DISPLAY  
4. KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
5. SYSTEM OPTIONS  
6. PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
7. SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
8. DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
9. S-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
10. SYSTEM PASSWORD  
11. SUPER MACRO SCAN  
12. ROM FILE DOWNLOAD  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
L1  
PORT  
DEVICE  
PRINTER TYPES  
PORT#1  
PORT#2  
PORT#3  
PORT#4  
PORT#5  
PORT#6  
PORT#7  
DISABLE  
PRINTER  
VIDEO  
POLLING  
SCALE  
SCANNER  
EFT TERMNAL  
CHANGER  
POLE DISPLAY  
LIQUOR  
SAM SRP-100  
SAM SRP-250  
SAM SRP-300  
CITIZEN 3541  
CITIZEN 810  
CITIZEN 230  
EPSON T88-2  
EPSON U200  
EPSON U295  
EPSON U300  
EPSON U325  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
77  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SERIAL PORT SELECTIONS - DEFINITIONS  
PORT  
This is the number of the physical port located on the terminal. There are three as standard with a maximum of  
seven  
DEVICE  
This is the peripheral which will connected to the port. The following options can be chosen.  
Disable  
Printer  
- The port is not active  
- The port will be used to operate a printer, you are then presented  
With a list of Printer types, all of which are pre-programmed with  
Driver setting.  
Video  
- This is a linked Kitchen Video System for the display of products  
- This is the on-line computer link.  
Polling  
Scale  
- This links to an approved scale for weighted items  
- This option enables a barcode scanner  
Scanner  
EFT Terminal  
Changer  
Pole Display  
- This option links an approved Electronic Fund Transfer Terminal  
- This option allows a coin changer to be connected.  
- This option allows a pole remote display to be connected.  
PRINTER TYPES  
When a printer is selected in device, this displays the options / chosen printer model  
78  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                   
                                                                   
DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
This is used to define the baud rate etc of a peripheral linked to the serial port, i.e.  
speed of scanning and other required settings  
S-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. SELF TESTS  
2. MEMORY CLEAR  
3. MEMORY ALLOCATION DISPLAY  
4. KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
5. SYSTEM OPTIONS  
6. PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
7. SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
8. DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
9. S-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
10. SYSTEM PASSWORD  
11. SUPER MACRO SCAN  
12. ROM FILE DOWNLOAD  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
SERIAL PORT#1 PARAMETER SELECTIONS L1  
PORT DESCRIPTION  
BAUD RATE  
PARITY  
DATA BITS  
STOP BITS  
RETRIES  
FEED LINES BEFORE PRINTING  
FEED LINES AFTER PRINTING  
PRINT BITMAP?  
PORT1  
009600•  
NONE•  
8•  
1•  
00  
00  
07  
N
LOGO SIZE (0-3)  
0
LINES ON “HARD” SLIP  
CUTTING AFTER PRINTING?  
00  
Y
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓←→  
79  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS - DEFINITIONS  
PORT DESCRIPTION  
This is an area in which you can type your own description of the task the port is carrying out, i.e. SHOP  
PRINTER, HAND SCANNER etc.. This description is for your own reference purposes.  
BAUD RATE  
This is the Baud Rate of the device, the communications speed of the peripheral  
DATA BITS  
This is a standard peripheral definition, the information is normally supplied with the device  
STOP BITS  
This is a standard peripheral definition, the information is normally supplied with the device  
RETRIES  
This is the number of attempts that will be made to communicate with a device before failure is declared the  
default settings are satisfactory for most commonly used peripherals.  
FEED LINES BEFORE PRINTING / AFTER PRINTING  
This the number of lines to be fed before or after the printing is started, this will make the receipt longer, helping  
format the ticket for non cutter printers.  
PRINT BITMAP?  
This allows printing of the previously downloaded graphics logo if the option has been defined as  
available within the memory allocation. Note the initalisation code for the graphics printer should be  
deleted using s-mode option, printer driver selections  
LOGO SIZE (0 – 3)  
This relates to the P.C. downloaded bit map image, each number relates to a different print format for the image.  
LOGO SIZE  
FORMAT  
LOGO SIZE  
FORMAT  
0
2
NORMAL  
1
3
DOUBLE WIDTH  
QUADRUPLE  
DOUBLE HEIGHT  
LINES ON “HARD” SLIP  
This is the number of lines that can be printed on a loose paper printer, before a prompt for the next page appears  
CUTTING AFTER PRINTING?  
When a printer has the capabilities of auto cut, this option will decide if that feature is to be used, i.e. for receipts  
it is commonly set to yes, however detail journal printers do not require this option  
80  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                   
                                                                   
S-MODE PROGRAM SCANS  
Programmed information can be sent to a printer so that a hard copy can be produced.  
This option is ideal for keeping records of your machines settings, these can then be stored for future reference.  
S-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. SELF TESTS  
2. MEMORY CLEAR  
3. MEMORY ALLOCATION DISPLAY  
4. KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
5. SYSTEM OPTIONS  
6. PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
7. SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
8. DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
9. S-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
10. SYSTEM PASSWORD  
11. SUPER MACRO SCAN  
12. ROM FILE DOWNLOAD  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
S-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
L1  
1. MEMORY ALLOCATION  
2. SYSTEM OPTIONS  
3. PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
4. SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
5. DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
81  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
S-MODE PROGRAM SCANS  
MEMORY ALLOCATION  
Print the definitions of the systems features and file maximums  
SYSTEM OPTIONS  
This prints the most basic of features such as terminal number and IRC (inter register communications) settings  
PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
This print out shows how technicians have customised printers.  
SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
This prints the function of each of the physical ports listing the peripheral type connected.  
DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
This prints the configuration of the ports, communication speed and unique settings  
82  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                   
                                                                   
SYSTEM PASSWORD  
The terminal can be restricted to the most basic of register uses. Using the employee  
authority password restriction for manager functions. It is possible by mistake to restrict  
access for yourself to programming. To prevent this the system has an in-built master  
password. When used as an employee code, by signing on with the EMPLOYEE# key in  
register mode this will allow access to all features enabling the user to program out the  
inappropriate restriction that had inadvertently been programmed.  
This password should be programmed and a record of the number kept when authority  
restrictions are used.  
Alternatively the default setting of 9999 can used if password override is required.  
S-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. SELF TESTS  
2. MEMORY CLEAR  
3. MEMORY ALLOCATION DISPLAY  
4. KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
5. SYSTEM OPTIONS  
6. PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
7. SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
8. DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
9. S-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
10. SYSTEM PASSWORD  
11. SUPER MACRO SCAN  
12. ROM FILE DOWNLOAD  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
SYSTEM PASSWORD  
L1  
SYSTEM PASSWORD (0000=NO PASSWD) 9999  
ESC ENTER  
83  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                   
                                                                   
SUPER MACRO SCAN  
The super macro file size is defined by the memory allocation sequence. This determes how many keystrokes can  
be stored in this section once the maximum limit has been stored wrap round reporting will begin i.e. line by line  
replacement of the oldest data The super macro file as acts the terminals log file recording all key pressing that  
are taking place. This section always that information to be printed.  
S-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. SELF TESTS  
2. MEMORY CLEAR  
3. MEMORY ALLOCATION DISPLAY  
4. KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
5. SYSTEM OPTIONS  
6. PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
7. SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
8. DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
9. S-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
10. SYSTEM PASSWORD  
11. SUPER MACRO SCAN  
12. ROM FILE DOWNLOAD  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
SUPER MACRO SCAN  
L1  
1. SUPER MACRO DISPLAY  
2. SUPER MACRO PRINTING  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
84  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ROM FILE DOWNLOAD  
This is used to transmit a PC downloaded flash ROM from the master terminal to the slaves within the system.  
(see the technical appendix for the PC ROM download procedure)  
CAUTION: After completing this section you must then reset all programmed  
information, back to the factory default settings using the program reset  
procedure  
This will erase the existing ROM and transmit a new flash ROM (which has been download from the P.C.) down  
the IRC network, Please consult the technical appendix for P.C. Flash ROM download procedures to tranmsit the  
rom from the P.C. When the ROM is transmitted only those set to receive will be amended, this will have no  
effect on any machines in the system not set.  
TO PREPARE RECEIVING TERMINALS  
1. Turn the power switch located on the right side of the register to  
the OFF position.  
2. Turn the key lock to the S-MODE position (one position clockwise  
from the PGM key lock position).  
3. Press and hold the key position where the CASH key is located on  
the default keyboard layout.  
4. Continue to hold the CASH key whilst turning the power switch to  
the ON position. (see figure 1)  
5. Press each of the four corner keys  
TOP LEFT, BOTTOM LEFT, TOP RIGHT, BOTTOM RIGHT (see  
figure 2)  
6. The screen will say download and is now waiting for the download  
procedure to be activated on the transmitting terminal.  
NOTE: Please carry out an initial all program clear after  
transmitting the ROM  
Figure 1.  
1st  
Figure 2.  
3rd  
7
4
1
0
8
9
6
T E N D 1  
C H E Q U E  
Press and hold  
this key position  
during power-up  
in S-MODE  
Press each  
of the four  
corner keys  
in turn  
5
S U B -  
T O T L  
2
3
.
C A S H  
0 0  
2nd  
4th  
85  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                   
                                                                   
ROM FILE DOWNLOAD  
TO PREPARE DOWNLOADING TERMINAL  
This is used to transmit a PC downloaded flash ROM from the master terminal to the slaves within the system.  
(see the technical appendix for the PC ROM download procedure) This menu option is password protected with a  
default of 9999 the password can be change using S-MODE, SYSTEM OPTIONS settings.  
S-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. SELF TESTS  
2. MEMORY CLEAR  
3. MEMORY ALLOCATION DISPLAY  
4. KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
5. SYSTEM OPTIONS  
The password  
can be found in  
S-mode system  
options  
6. PRINTER D
PASSWORD : 0000  
7. SERIAL PONS  
8. DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
9. S-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
10. SYSTEM PASSWORD  
11. SUPER MACRO SCAN  
12. ROM FILE DOWNLOAD  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
DOWNLOADING...  
ADDRESS (00xxxxxx)  
30% COMPLETED  
86  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                   
                                                                   
LOAD DEFAULT MESSAGES  
This will revert back to default text any messages which have been changed from their original settings  
S-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
4. KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
5. SYSTEM OPTIONS  
6. PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
7. SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
8. DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
9. S-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
10. SYSTEM PASSWORD  
11. SUPER MACRO SCAN  
12. ROM FILE DOWNLOAD  
13. LOAD DEFAULT MESSAGES  
14. CHECK UNLOCK  
15. CLERK UNLOCK  
%
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
ERROR MESSAGES  
These are the onscreen display prompts warning the operator of mis-operations.  
Following is a list of the standard error messages,  
SYSTEM DESCRIPTORS  
These are the onscreen and reporting messages designed to assist the operator.  
Following is a list of the standard error messages.  
87  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFAULT ERROR MESSAGES  
NO.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
DESCRIPTION  
(NOT USE)  
(NOT USE)  
AMOUNT REQUIRED  
BAD VALUE  
BUFFER FULL  
NO. DESCRIPTION  
111  
112  
113  
114  
115  
116  
117  
118  
119  
120  
121  
122  
123  
124  
125  
126  
127  
128  
129  
130  
131  
132  
133  
134  
135  
136  
137  
138  
139  
140  
141  
142  
143  
144  
145  
146  
147  
148  
149  
150  
151  
152  
153  
154  
155  
156  
157  
158  
159  
160  
161  
162  
163  
NEGATIVE CARD  
LINKED STATUS REQUIRED  
RETURN TO X-MODE  
ERROR - SLIP PAPER  
LOCAL PRINTER REQUIRED  
MODE ERROR  
BUFFER EMPTY  
BUSY  
SET TIME&DATE IS DECATIVATED  
EMPLOYEE SHOULD BE DIFFERENT  
TRANSFER NOT ALLOWED  
REQ GALLONAGE AMOUNT  
AVAILABLE ONLY IN CHECK  
SPLIT THIS ITEM NOT POSSIBLE  
FUNCTION KEY NOT INCLUDED  
ERROR POST TENDER  
NO TRACKING DATA IN THIS REG  
NO TIME KEEP DATA IN THIS REG  
MULTIPLICATION LIMIT EXCEEDED  
TAB OF FIELD2 TOO BIG  
NON-PLU CODE RANGE OVER  
TARE ENTRY NOT ALLOWED  
MISC TEND REQUIRED  
SAME CHECK TRACK REQUIRED  
NOT SCALEABLE PLU  
EJ BUFFER FULL  
MUST BE START<=END IN RANGE  
RANGE OVERLAP  
FINAL END SHOULD BE 9 OR 99  
NOT PLU  
BAD COMMAND  
CASH DECALATION REQUIRED  
CASH-IN-DRAWER EXCEEDED  
CHECK# ASSIGNED AUTO  
CHECK# REQUIRED !  
CONDIMENT REQUIRED!  
CRC ERROR  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
51  
52  
53  
DUPLICATE!  
ANALYSIS1/2/3  
ENTER EMPLOYEE CODE  
ENTER EMPLOYEE #  
ENTER GUEST COUNT  
ENTER SEAT#  
ENTER TABLE#  
ENTRY REQUIRED  
ERROR  
ERROR JAM  
TABLE NUMBER IN USE  
HALO OVER!  
ILLEGAL KEY SEQUENCE  
IN USE!  
INACTIVE!  
NOT WLU  
PRINT KEY REQUIRED  
INPUT QTY  
KITCHEN PRINTER FAILURE  
MANAGER REQUIRED  
MANAGER OVERRIDE REQUIRE  
MEMORY FULL  
NEGATIVE  
NO CHECK#  
NO DATA  
NO DRAWER!  
NO MANUAL ENTRY  
NO PAPER  
NO PLU!  
NON ADD# REQUIRED  
NOT DISCOUNTABLE  
NOT PROGRAMMED!  
NOT READY!  
NOT ZERO  
OFF LINE!  
OPEN DRAWER  
P/BAL REQUIRED  
PAPER END  
RANGE OVER  
REMOVE PAPER  
SCALE FAIL!  
SURCHARGE NOT ALLOWED  
DECIMAL ENTRY REQUIRED  
SYSTEM REG# REQUIRED  
TRAINING EMP FILE# REQUIRED  
TIME IN/OUT REG# REQUIRED  
CHECK TRACKING REG# REQUIRED  
ELECTRONIC JOURNAL INACTIVE  
CHEQUE ENDORSEMENT REQUIRED  
EFT TERMIANL TRANS. KEY ERROR  
CARD ERROR  
PRINTER OFFLINE  
KV OFFLINE  
NO RELOCATABLE KEY  
CLERK KEY ERROR  
ENFORCE ACTUAL INVENTORY  
AUTHORITY LEVEL NOT LINKED  
WEIGHT IS ZERO  
STOCK IS NOT ZERO  
CLEAR CAN NOT BE REMOVED  
ENTER CAN NOT BE REMOVED  
YES/NO CAN NOT BE REMOVED  
THIS NUMERIC CAN’T BE REMOVED  
INCORRECT CODE  
88  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFAULT ERROR MESSAGES  
54  
55  
56  
57  
58  
59  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
65  
66  
67  
68  
SCALE REQUIRED!  
SINGLE ITEM!  
SUBTOTAL REQUIRED  
SYSTEM ERROR  
TARE# REQUIRED  
TRAY SUBTOTAL REQUIRED!  
VALIDATION REQUIRED  
WASTE REQUIRED!  
WRONG EMPLOYEE  
SIGN OFF REQUIRED  
164  
165  
166  
167  
168  
169  
170  
171  
172  
173  
174  
175  
176  
177  
178  
SOFT CHECK ONLY  
INACTIVE PLU  
MULTIPLE DISCOUNT NOT ALLOWED  
NEW CHECK OPENED  
NO MORE SPLIT TENDER ALLOWED  
CHECK POLE DISPLAY  
MUST MAX.NONTAXABLE<=BRK PNT1  
MUST BRK PNT n <= BRK PNT n+1  
NOT ALLOWED WITH OPEN ORDERS  
NOW POLLING !!  
INCORRECT TARE WEIGHT  
MIX AND MATCH ERROR  
CLERK INTERRUPT ERROR  
CHECK OPENED NO DATA  
NO CLERK BUFFER IN THIS REG  
ZERO AMOUNT  
PRICE LEVEL MISMATCH  
OVERRIDE NOT ALLOWED  
WRONG SEQUENCE  
WRONG COMMAND  
69  
WRONG FILE NO  
70  
71  
72  
73  
WRONG ITEMMIZER  
UNDER TEND NOT ALLOWED  
OVER TEND NOT ALLOWED  
CHECK TRACKING ERROR  
USING  
74  
75  
PLU NOT ALLOWED  
76  
77  
78  
79  
CONDIMENT PLU NOT ALLOWED  
NON-CONDIMENT PLU NOT ALLOWED  
FUNCTION KEY NOT ALLOWED  
THIS KEY NOT ALLOWED  
NO FUNCTION KEY  
80  
81  
82  
NO PROGRAMMABLE KEY  
X/TIME REQUIRED  
83  
84  
INVALID AUTHORITY LEVEL  
TIME IN REQUIRED  
85  
SIGN ON REQUIRED  
86  
87  
88  
MEMORY NOT ALLOCATED  
THIS EMP. RPT MUST BE CLEARED  
ERROR STATUS  
89  
ERROR VALUE  
90  
91  
ERROR SYSTEM OPTION  
ERORR EMPLOYEE  
92  
ERROR TABLE NO  
93  
SCALE MOTION  
94  
OVER WEIGHT  
95  
UNDER WEIGHT  
96  
97  
98  
PROMO NOT ALLOWED  
WASTE NOT ALLOWED  
NO FOOD STAMP AMOUNT  
DECIMAL ENTRY NOT ALLOWED  
SPLIT PRICING NOT ALLOWED  
VOID MODE IS DEACTIVATED  
JOB CODE REQUIRED  
JOB CODE CHANGE NOT ALLOWED  
PUSH BUTTON ENTRY REQUIRED  
EMPLOYEE CODE NOT LINKED  
TENDERING IS NOT ALLOWED  
OVER REGULAR HOURS PER WEEK  
MUST <= LINE# PER TRANSACTION  
MUST >= LINE# PER SOFT CHECK  
NO STOCK PLU  
99  
100  
101  
102  
103  
104  
105  
106  
107  
108  
109  
110  
89  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFAULT SYSTEM DESCRIPTORS  
NO.  
1
DESCRIPTION  
SUN  
NO.  
55  
DESCRIPTION  
PAYMENT  
2
3
MON  
TUE  
56  
57  
HOME AMT  
FSCRT  
4
WED  
58  
FS EXMT  
5
6
7
8
THU  
FRI  
SAT  
MGR  
TAXES  
TOTAL  
FSTAX  
FSTTL  
FSCNG  
DATE  
TIME  
NO.  
CASH  
CHEQ  
MISC  
REG  
PLU#  
PBAL  
SEAT#  
ESC  
TBL  
GST  
EMPL.  
FOR  
59  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
65  
66  
67  
68  
69  
70  
71  
72  
73  
74  
75  
76  
77  
78  
79  
80  
81  
82  
83  
84  
85  
86  
87  
88  
89  
90  
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
97  
98  
99  
100  
101  
102  
103  
104  
105  
106  
107  
108  
109  
SCALE CANCEL  
TIP PAID OUT  
TIP DECLARED  
TAXABLE 1  
TAXABLE 2  
TAXABLE 3  
TAXABLE 4  
TAXABLE 5  
TAXABLE 6  
TAX1 AMT  
TAX2 AMT  
TAX3 AMT  
TAX4 AMT  
TAX5 AMT  
TAX6 AMT  
VAT1 AMT  
VAT2 AMT  
VAT3 AMT  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
51  
52  
53  
54  
VAT4 AMT  
VAT5 AMT  
VAT6 AMT  
EXEMPT TAX1  
EXEMPT TAX2  
EXEMPT TAX3  
EXEMPT TAX4  
EXEMPT TAX5  
EXEMPT TAX6  
TAX TOTAL  
NO SEAT  
POST TENDER  
SYSTEM  
BALANCE  
CHECK#  
CLOCK OUT  
CLOSED  
PRICE/HALO  
DESCRIPTOR  
LINK GROUP  
LINK STATUS  
CHANGE RATE  
FOREIGN AMT  
REG MODE  
VD MODE  
MGR MODE  
CONV  
GAS CNT  
GAS AMT  
ORDER#  
AMOUNT REQUIRED  
*****TRAINING*****  
TIME CLOCK – IN  
TIME CLOCK – OUT  
EMPLOYEE SIGN ON  
EMPLOYEE SIGN OFF  
DECLARE CASH TIPS  
↑↓←→ ENT  
↑↓←→ ENT DONE  
↑↓←→ ENT X/TM  
↑↓←→ ENT DONE X/TM  
ADD CHECKS FOR PAYMENT  
** NOT CLOSED CHECKS **  
ENTER NEW SEAT#  
EMPLOYEE  
AMT DUE  
CHANGE  
JOB CODE  
SUMMARY  
OUT FOR BRK  
OUT  
OPERATOR  
NON-ADD#  
INPUT QTY  
ENTER TIME:  
TRANS VD  
REPRINT  
GROUP0  
DELETED PLU  
90  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                   
                                                                   
UNLOCK PROCEDURES  
This will reset an locked operational checks or clerk interrupt details. This must be perfomed on the terminal set  
to store the data in the s-mode system option settings.  
S-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
4. KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
5. SYSTEM OPTIONS  
6. PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS  
7. SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS  
8. DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS  
9. S-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
10. SYSTEM PASSWORD  
11. SUPER MACRO SCAN  
12. ROM FILE DOWNLOAD  
13. LOAD DEFAULT MESSAGES  
14. CHECK UNLOCK  
15. CLERK UNLOCK  
%
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
CHECK UNLOCK  
Used in the unlikely event that an open check track number becomes locked and inoperable  
CLERK UNLOCK  
Used in the unlikely even that an open clerk interrupt buffer becomes locked and inoperable.  
91  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
92  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
P-MODE  
93  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                              
                              
PLU – PROGRAMMING  
During PLU Programming, each PLU is assigned a descriptor, price or prices and a few unique  
options.  
The remainder of the PLU options are determined by linking the individual PLU to a PLU Status Group.  
The PLU Status Group contains all of the detailed programming option selections that might be  
assigned to a product. Separate PLU Status Groups are defined to accommodate the needs of groups  
of PLUs. Like PLUs, the total number of PLU Status Groups is determined by memory allocation.  
NOTE When programming PLUs the cursor by defaults starts at the group link input flag using a  
system flag this can be change so that entry starts at the price field, using the page up/down keys to  
scroll through records this makes bulk prices changes faster to program.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
PLU PROGRAMMING  
L1  
1. PLU  
2. PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. GROUP  
1. ADD & CHANGE  
2. DELETE  
4. FUNCTION KEY  
5. SYSTEM OPTION  
6. TAXES  
7. MESSAGES  
8. WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
9. TIME PERIOD  
Note Delete can be used to  
remove single items or a  
range providing there are no  
sales/stock totals stored  
10. EMPLOYEE  
11. AUTHORITY LEVEL  
12. PRINTER TABLES & KV ROUTING  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
PLU#000000000000000001 PROGRAMMING L1  
PLU#000000000000000000 PROGRAMMING L1  
•PRESS THE PLU TO BE PROGRAMMED  
OR  
DESCRIPTOR :  
PINT OF BITTER  
STOCK LINK PLU#  
000000000000000000  
MODIFIER QTY 0000 GROUP LINK #1  
PLU STATUS LINK#  
01  
01  
01  
PIECE COUNT  
001 RECIPE#  
ACTIVATE WLU# 00 MIX&MTCH TABLE# 00  
•ENTER THE PLU NUMBER AND PRESS ENTER  
OR  
INACTIVE  
PRESET?  
Y
PRODUCT MIX#  
000  
Y ALLOW PRICE CHANGE?Y  
ALLOW PRESET/HALO OVERRIDE?  
Y
PRICE/HALO 000002.20 PRICE LEVEL#1? 01  
PRICE/HALO 000001.20 PRICE LEVEL#2? 02  
PRICE/HALO 000002.20 PRICE LEVEL#3? 01  
PRICE/HALO 000003.20 PRICE LEVEL#4? 15  
PRICE/HALO 000004.20 PRICE LEVEL#5? 20  
PLU# ESC Y/N ENT PAGE UP/DN ↓←→  
•ENTER THE PLU NUMBER AND PRESS PLU#  
PLU# ESC ENTER INDIVIDUAL PLU  
94  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLU – DEFINITIONS  
DESCRIPTOR  
This is the name of the saleable item, which will appear on receipts and reports.  
STOCK LINK PLU#  
It is possible when managing stock, the principle of buy one reduce one from stock that a number of items may  
need to reduce from the same stock item for example half pints of beer from a print. This is the item from which  
the stock will be reduced after the sale of this code number  
MODIFIER QTY  
This works in conjunction with the stock link PLU flag determining how many units are to be reduced from the  
main stock item. The field consists of two decimal places for example 50 would result in 0.50 being reduced  
from the stock of the item program within the stock link PLU field.  
GROUP LINK #1  
This field is used to provide the first type of sales analysis by category i.e. Beer, Lagers  
PLU STATUS LINK#  
This is the programming for the status group link. Providing an en-masse program procedure for common system  
flags  
PIECE COUNT  
This is the number of units to be used from a product mix group, case, as this product is sold.  
For example a jumbo burger, requires 2 units of the Burger bought by the Dozen product mix group  
This field is then set to 2, so that for each item sold 2 burgers out of a case of 12 are recorded  
RECIPE#  
This links to the ingredient inventory, so that when the product is sold, the quantities of each ingredient used are  
subtracted from stock for the allocated recipe and the appropriate sub recipes.  
ACTIVATE WLU#  
When a WLU# key is not being activated by a WLU# key, it can be attached to the PLU.  
This is used mainly when the window applies solely to a product i.e. Cooking instructions etc..  
MIX&MATCH TABLE#  
This is the promotion discount table, when the product or a mix of products, allocated to the same table are sold  
the appropriate discount information from the mix and match table will be subtracted.  
INACTIVE  
This prevents the product from being sold, without deleting therefore still retaining accumulated product sales  
data.  
95  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLU – DEFINITIONS  
PRODUCT MIX#  
This works inconjunction with the piece count to track the unit and case usage of an item, each product can be  
programmed with the number of pieces used from an outer, ie the number of bottles from a case. The piece count  
would control the number of bottles and the product mix group would control the description of the item and the  
number of units in case. In this field you would link the item to the product mix group.  
PRESET?  
This determines whether the product is a pre-set or open price.  
ALLOW PRESET/HALO OVERRIDE?  
This allows the operator to either manually enter over a pre-set priced item or to override a maximum sale limit.  
This works per PLU, with each product having individual restriction.If global restriction is required change the setting in  
systems options  
PRICE/HALO 1 - 5  
This is either the pre-set price of an item, or the maximum sale amount of an open product.  
PRICE LEVEL#1 - 5  
Entered here is the price level, for each product .There are 5 different prices per product, with up to twenty price  
levels available to be allocated. This allows the user to create a matrix of PLUs and Prices each accessed by one  
of the twenty price keys. When the price key is priced the product is then checked to determine if that price level  
(1-20) exists in any one of the five prices available. The standard is two prices per product set to price 1 and 2  
this is generated as standard. A product price level sales report is available showing the total quantity and value  
sold per price and overall per product also a total for each price. This feature is not related to the five keyboard  
levels, they work independently  
96  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                               
                               
                                                                                                                       
                                                                                                                       
PLU STATUS GROUP – PROGRAMMING  
PLU Status Groups allow memory to be used more efficiently. In most applications, large  
groups of PLUs are set with many identical options, while the PLU number, descriptor and  
price are unique. On the PLU Programming each PLU is assigned a descriptor, price or  
prices and a few unique options. The remainder, of the PLU options are determined by  
linking the individual PLU to a PLU Status Group. The PLU Status Group contains all of the  
detailed programming selections that might be assigned to an individual PLU. Separate PLU  
Status Groups can be set up to accommodate the needs of groups of PLUs. Like PLUs, the  
total number of PLU Status Groups is determined by memory allocation.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
PLU STATUS GROUP# 1 PROGRAMMING L1  
1. PLU  
2. PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. GROUP  
4. FUNCTION KEY  
5. SYSTEM OPTION  
6. TAXES  
DESCRIPTOR :  
BAR PROGRAM  
1 2 3 4 5 6  
Y N N N N N  
01  
1. TAXABLE BY RATES?  
2. GROUP LINK #2  
3. GROUP LINK #3  
4. ARE PLUS IN THIS GROUP INACTIVE?  
5. IS PLU A CONDIMENT?  
51  
Y
N
7. MESSAGES  
8. WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
9. TIME PERIOD  
6. COMPULSORY CONDIMENT ENTRY?  
7. IS PLU SINGLE ITEM?  
N
N
10. EMPLOYEE  
11. AUTHORITY LEVEL  
12. PRINTER TABLES & KV ROUTING  
8. IS PLU NEGATIVE?  
9. IS PLU HASH?  
10. DOES PLU USE GALLONAGE?  
N
N
N
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓←→  
PLU STATUS GROUP# 1 PROGRAMMING L1  
PLU STATUS GROUP# 1 PROGRAMMING L1  
11. IS PLU FOOD STAMP ELIGIBLE?  
12. IS PLU MEMO?  
13. IS PLU SCALEABLE?  
14. AUTO SCALE ON THIS PLU ?  
15. AUTO TARE# (0-20)  
16. STOCK PLU?  
N
N
N
23. COMPULSORTY VALIDATION  
24. IS NON-ADD# COMPULSORY?  
25. PRINT ON KV?  
26. KITCHEN VIDEO GROUP #  
27. COLOR TO DISPLAY ON KV (0-31)  
28. PRINT ON KP?  
N
N
N
00  
00  
Y
N
00  
N
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9  
17. LINK PLU#  
0000000000000000000  
29. PRINT ON KP GROUP# Y N N N N N N N N  
18. NEGATIVE INVENTORY?  
19. ALLOW PROMO?  
20. ALLOW WASTE?  
21. ALLOW DISCOUNT?  
22. ALLOW SURCHARGE?  
Y
Y
Y
Y
30. PRINT RED ON KITCHEN PRINTERS?  
31. PRINT RED ON RECEIPT?  
32. PRINT ON RECEIPT?  
Y
N
Y
Y
33. PRINT ON JOURNAL?  
Y
"
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓←→  
"
ESC Y/N
 
ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓←→  
97  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLU STATUS GROUP – DEFINITIONS  
TAXABLE BY RATES?  
This applies the selected pre-programmed tax rate to this item  
GROUP LINK #2  
This field is used to provide the second sales analysis by category i.e. Draught Beers etc.  
GROUP LINK #3  
This field is used to provide the third sales analysis by category i.e. Wet, Dry sales etc.  
ARE PLUS IN THIS GROUP INACTIVE?  
This will disable the sale of a product. Ideal when totalisers are still being stored  
IS PLU A CONDIMENT?  
A condiment is a way of amending a product, either priced such as salad, (totals are treated the same as PLU  
sales) or zero priced such as cooking instructions. The print format changes, indenting to indicate the item that is  
a condiment. It is also not possible to sell a condiment without a normal PLU product being sold. I.e. no side  
salad without a main meal.  
COMPULSORY CONDIMENT ENTRY?  
This forces the entry of a condiment after the sale of an item, i.e. a steak may require cooking instructions to be  
entered immediately. This would be set to the normal PLU ensuring a condiment PLU is pressed directly after the  
sale.  
IS PLU SINGLE ITEM?  
This feature automatically finalises the sale when this product is sold, assuming a cash payment  
IS PLU NEGATIVE?  
This changes permanently the retail price of the item to a negative sale  
IS PLU HASH?  
This allows the sales quantity and values of an item to be treated differently, these are not added to the same  
financial totals as ordinary products. The totaliser to which the information is added are control by system  
programming, it will be required that you set these system options according to the specifications for your items.  
A H is show alongside the PLU on the PLU trading report to indicate the item is a HASH PLU (providing the  
PLU HASH option is set to include sales on the PLU report)  
DOES PLU USE GALLONAGE?  
Gallonage PLUs must be set as open PLUs. The PRICE/HALO must be set as the price per gallon (the price is  
set at three decimal places ($1.299) Gallonage PLUs will report the gallons sold in the activity counter on the  
PLU report by dividing the PLU total by the price per gallon.  
IS PLU FOOD STAMP ELIGIBLE?  
98  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This is an American feature where payment can be received by government food vouchers This ensures products  
are available for sale with payment by voucher  
PLU STATUS GROUP – DEFINITIONS  
IS PLU MEMO?  
This enables all PLU information to be printed, but not calculated to totalisers, i.e. a description print  
IS PLU SCALEABLE?  
This allows the product to be a weighted item, and register the weight programmed.  
AUTO SCALE ON THIS PLU?  
If Y, is entered registrations of PLUs linked to this group will automatically multiply by the weight placed upon a  
scale connected to the register.  
AUTO TARE# (0 - 20)  
If Y,is entered the tare# indicated here will automatically subtract the weight from the scale.  
STOCK PLU?  
Is this product to be included in the stock taking ? i.e. will stock / deliveries be entered for this product.  
NEGATIVE INVENTORY?  
This converts the positive stock counts entered for ingredients into negative totals.  
ALLOW PROMO?  
Is this product available for promotion sales?  
ALLOW WASTE?  
Is this product allowed to register stock wastage totals entered by the operator?  
ALLOW DISCOUNT?  
This controls whether a product is included when a monetary or percent discount is carried out.  
ALLOW SURCHARGE?  
This controls whether a product is included when a monetary or percent premium is carried out.  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
If this product is sold, validation printing is required. (Available only on a printer with a validation sensor)  
IS NON-ADD# COMPULSORY?  
This forces the operator to enter a reference number after the sale of this product  
PRINT ON KV?  
99  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This determines whether the product is printed on the Kitchen Video display  
PLU STATUS GROUP – DEFINITIONS  
COLOR TO DISPLAY ON KV (0-31)  
This is the colour in which the information is to be displayed on the Video System  
PRINT ON KP?  
If this is set to Y the item is available for print on upto 9 kitchen printer routes, required for use with the PRINT  
key.  
PRINT ON KP GROUP# 1 - 9  
This is the group for the items to be printed on the kitchen printer, for example all bar items may be in group 1  
and the food in group 2. The kitchen printer setup will then determine which pyhsical printer prints, which group  
at which times.  
PRINT RED ON KITCHEN PRINTERS?  
Print products on the order in red. This is designed for Red/Black Printers, a thermal printer will invert  
PRINT RED ON RECEIPT?  
Print products on the receipt in red. This is designed for Red/Black Printers, a thermal printer will invert  
PRINT ON RECEIPT?  
This controls the product printing on the receipt, a priced item with no price printing will still be included in the  
sale total.  
PRINT ON JOURNAL?  
This controls whether the product prints on the journal printer  
DISPLAY ON THE REGISTER SCREEN?  
This controls whether the product prints on the main register display.  
PRINT ON GUEST CHECKS?  
This controls the product printing on the bill, a priced item with will still be included in the sale total.  
PRINT PRICE ON GUEST CHECKS?  
This controls whether the product’s retail price prints on the check bill, still to be included in total  
PRINT PRICE ON RECEIPT/DETAIL?  
This controls whether the product retail price prints on the receipt and detail journal printers  
AUTO GRILL?  
Items may be programmed as AUTO GRILL this ensures the item is sent to the printer immediately  
100  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTO GRILL KP GROUP #  
This is the print group to be allocated to the printer programming to control where the item is printed  
101  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                                  
                                                                                  
GROUP – PROGRAMMING  
Groups are designated to accumulate PLU sales for reporting analysis. A PLU can store  
sales information in up to 3 groups.  
Group Link #1 is set in PLU programming.  
Group Links #2 and #3 are set in PLU Status Group programming.  
This program allows you to set names to the groups that PLU sales will report to up to 99  
groups are available.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. PLU  
2. PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. GROUP  
4. FUNCTION KEY  
5. SYSTEM OPTION  
6. TAXES  
7. MESSAGES  
8. WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
9. TIME PERIOD  
10. EMPLOYEE  
11. AUTHORITY LEVEL  
12. PRINTER TABLES & KV ROUTING  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
GROUP# 1 PROGRAMMING  
L1  
BAR AREA 1  
DESCRIPTOR  
:
ADD TO GROUP TOTAL?  
Y
1 2 3 4 5 6  
TAXABLE BY RATE FOR ANLAYSIS2Y N N N N N  
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓←→  
102  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GROUP – DEFINITIONS  
ADD TO GROUP TOTAL?  
This determines if the total sales for this category are to be included in the total of all group sales on the read and  
reset analysis reports. It requires that only one of the three group that an item is linked to is included in the group  
totals otherwise the figures will be inaccurate.  
TAXABLE BY RATE FOR ANALYSIS2  
If this option is set when the analysis 2 function key is used in REG mode the taxable status of the item no longer  
follows the normal PLU tax rate but is taxed at the rate programmed to this field  
EXAMPLE GROUP STRUCTURING  
PLUs 1-  
10 are DRAUGHT BEERS items  
PLUs 11 – 20 are MINERALS items  
group 1 BAR  
Etc…  
PLUs 101 - 110 are STARTER items  
PLUs 111 – 120 are MAIN COURSE items  
group 2 FOOD  
both the above linked to PLU status  
both the above linked to PLU status  
An analysis is required for each type of saleable product, also a total for the drink items and a total for food  
items, with an overall restaurant sales total  
The following programming method would provide that analysis.  
GROUPS  
PROGRAMMING  
1
2
3
4
-
-
-
-
DRAUGHT BEERS linked to PLUs 1– 10 using GROUP#1 field in PLU program  
MINERALS  
linked to PLUs 11–110 using GROUP#1 field in PLU program  
linked to PLUs 101–110 using GROUP#1 field in PLU program  
linked to PLUs 111 –120 using GROUP#1 field in PLU program  
STARTERS  
MAIN COURSE  
51  
52  
-
-
DRINK SALES  
FOOD SALES  
linked to 1 – BAR  
linked to 2 – FOOD PLU Status group using GROUP#2 field  
PLU Status group using GROUP#2 field  
76  
-
RESTRN TOTAL linked to 1 - BAR  
PLU Status group using GROUP#3 field  
also linked to 2 - FOOD PLU Status group using GROUP#3 field  
The group programming would be set so only groups less than 50 added into the group total ie all Draughts,  
Minerals etc.. whilst groups greater than 51 would not be added to the group total, therefore ensuring the total on  
the group sales read is always correct.  
103  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                             
                                                                             
                                                                                                                
                                                                                                                
FUNCTION KEY – PROGRAMMING  
Function key options vary by key, each feature is explained in the following pages.  
Function keys may exist on different levels of the keyboard, or they may only be accessed  
through WLUs, they may also be addressed by directly pressing the key, or by entering the  
function key code number.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. PLU  
2. PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. GROUP  
4. FUNCTION KEY  
5. SYSTEM OPTION  
6. TAXES  
7. MESSAGES  
8. WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
9. TIME PERIOD  
10. EMPLOYEE  
11. AUTHORITY LEVEL  
12. PRINTER TABLES & KV ROUTING  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
FUNCTION KEY # 0 PROGRAMMING  
L1  
FUNCTION KEY #214 PROGRAMMING  
L1  
PRESS THE KEY TO BE PROGRAMMED  
DEFAULT DESC :  
DESCRIPTOR :  
HALO (0:NO LIMIT)  
STORE CHK1  
HOLD RESTAUR  
00000.00  
1 2 3 4 5 6  
OR  
•ENTER THE KEY NUMBER AND PRESS ENTER  
OR  
EXEMPT TAX :  
N N N N N N  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY?  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION?  
NON-ADD# COMPULSORY?  
PRINT ON RECEIPT?  
N
N
N
PRESS ENTER TO VIEW A FUNCTION LIST  
OR  
Y
•PRESS THE WLU WHERE THE FUNCTOION IS  
LOCATED AND SELECT THE APPROPRIATE  
FUNCTION  
PRINT ON JOURNAL?  
SERVICE OF NEGATIVE BALANCE IN X ONLY? N  
HARD CHECK PRINTER # (0-40) 00  
Y
ESC WLU ENTER FUNCTION KEY  
!
ESC Y/N
 
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓←→  
104  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY – LISTING  
CODE  
1
NAME  
CODE  
70  
71  
72  
73  
74  
75  
76  
77  
78  
79  
80  
81  
82  
83  
84  
85  
86  
87  
88  
89  
90  
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
NAME  
CODE  
139  
140  
141  
142  
143  
144  
145  
146  
147  
148  
149  
150  
151  
152  
153  
154  
155  
156  
157  
158  
159  
160  
161  
162  
163  
164  
NAME  
NUMERIC 1  
NUMERIC 2  
NUMERIC 3  
NUMERIC 4  
NUMERIC 5  
NUMERIC 6  
NUMERIC 7  
NUMERIC 8  
NUMERIC 9  
NUMERIC 0  
NUMERIC 00  
NUMERIC 000  
ADD CHECK  
BACK SPACE  
BOLD  
MACRO PAUSE  
MACRO R (REG)  
MACRO S (S-MODE)  
MACRO SET (RECORD)  
MACRO VOID  
MACRO X  
MODIFIER4  
MODIFIER5  
MODIFIER6  
MODIFIER7  
MODIFIER8  
MODIFIER9  
MODIFIER10  
NEXT RECORD  
#/NOSALE  
P/BAL  
2
3
4
5
6
7
MACRO Z  
8
MACRO1  
9
MACRO2  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
MACRO3  
MACRO4  
PAGE DOWN  
PAGE UP  
PAID OUT1  
PAID OUT2  
PAID OUT2  
PAID OUT4  
PAID OUT5  
PAID RECALL  
% 1  
MACRO5  
MACRO6  
MACRO7  
MACRO8  
CANCEL  
MACRO9  
CAPS  
MACRO10  
MACRO11  
MACRO12  
MACRO13  
MACRO14  
MACRO15  
MACRO16  
MACRO17  
MACRO18  
MACRO19  
CASH  
TIP DECLARE  
SLIP  
% 2  
CHEQUE  
% 3  
CHEQUE CASH  
CHK ENDORSE  
CLEAR  
% 4  
% 5  
% 6  
CONTINUE  
% 7  
CURR.CONV 1  
EURO  
% 8  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
CURR.CONV 2  
CURR.CONV 3  
CURR.CONV 4  
CURR.CONV 5  
CUR DOWN  
96  
97  
MACRO20  
MACRO21  
MACRO22  
MACRO23  
MACRO24  
MACRO25  
165  
166  
167  
168  
169  
170  
% 9  
% 10  
98  
PLU  
99  
PREV.RECORD  
PRICE INQ  
PRICE LVL1  
100  
101  
CUR LEFT  
105  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY – LISTING  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
51  
52  
53  
54  
55  
56  
57  
58  
59  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
65  
66  
CUR RIGHT  
CUR UP  
102  
103  
104  
105  
106  
107  
108  
109  
110  
111  
112  
113  
114  
115  
116  
117  
118  
119  
120  
121  
122  
123  
124  
125  
126  
127  
128  
129  
130  
131  
132  
133  
134  
135  
MACRO26  
171  
172  
173  
174  
175  
176  
177  
178  
179  
180  
181  
182  
183  
184  
185  
186  
187  
188  
189  
190  
191  
192  
193  
194  
195  
196  
197  
198  
199  
200  
201  
202  
203  
204  
PRICE LVL2  
PRICE LVL3  
PRICE LVL4  
PRICE LVL5  
PRICE LVL6  
PRICE LVL7  
PRICE LVL8  
PRICE LVL9  
PRICE LVL10  
PRICE LVL11  
PRICE LVL12  
PRICE LVL13  
PRICE LVL14  
PRICE LVL15  
PRICE LVL16  
PRICE LVL17  
PRICE LVL18  
PRICE LVL19  
PRICE LVL20  
PRINT  
MACRO27  
DECIMAL  
MACRO28  
DELETE  
MACRO29  
DONE  
MACRO30  
ANALYSIS3  
ANALYSIS1  
EMPLOYEE  
EMPLOYEE1  
EMPLOYEE2  
EMPLOYEE3  
EMPLOYEE4  
EMPLOYEE5  
EMPLOYEE6  
EMPLOYEE7  
EMPLOYEE8  
EMPLOYEE9  
EMPLOYEE10  
ENTER  
MACRO31  
MACRO32  
MACRO33  
MACRO34  
MACRO35  
MACRO36  
MACRO37  
MACRO38  
MACRO39  
MACRO40  
MACRO # (CODE NO.)  
MDSE RETURN  
MISC TEND1  
MISC TEND2  
MISC TEND3  
MISC TEND4  
MISC TEND5  
MISC TEND6  
MISC TEND7  
MISC TEND8  
MISC TEND9  
MISC TEND10  
MISC TEND11  
MISC TEND12  
MISC TEND13  
MISC TEND14  
MISC TEND15  
MISC TEND16  
MISC TEND#  
ERR.CORR.  
FD/S SHIFT  
FD/S SUBTL  
FD/S TEND  
GUEST #  
PRINT CHECK  
PRINT HOLD  
PROMO  
PRT SCREEN  
QUIT  
HOLD  
INACTIVE  
RCPT ON/OFF  
RECALL CHK1  
RECALL CHK2  
RECALL CHK3  
RECALL CHK4  
RECD ACCT1  
RECD ACCT2  
RECD ACCT3  
RECD ACCT4  
KEYBD LVL1  
KEYBD LVL2  
KEYBD LVL3  
KEYBD LVL4  
KEYBD LVL5  
LIST CHECK1  
LIST CHECK2  
LIST CHECK3  
106  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY – LISTING  
67  
LIST CHECK4  
MACRO OFF  
MACRO P  
136  
137  
138  
231  
232  
233  
234  
235  
236  
237  
238  
239  
240  
241  
242  
243  
244  
245  
246  
247  
248  
249  
250  
251  
252  
253  
MODIFIER1  
MODIFIER2  
MODIFIER3  
TIME IN/OUT (CLOCK IN/OUT)  
TIP1  
205  
206  
207  
254  
255  
RECD ACCT5  
RECEIPT  
68  
69  
REPEAT  
208  
209  
210  
211  
212  
213  
214  
215  
216  
217  
218  
219  
220  
221  
222  
223  
224  
225  
226  
227  
228  
229  
230  
SCALE  
NOFOUND PLU  
PRICE CHG  
SEAT #  
SHIFT  
TIP2  
SPLIT ITEM  
SPLIT PAY  
STOCK INQ  
STORE CHK1  
STORE CHK2  
STORE CHK3  
STORE CHK4  
SUBTOTAL  
TABLE 1  
TIP3  
TRANS CHK1  
TRANS CHK2  
TRANS CHK3  
TRANS CHK4  
TRAY SUBTL (TICKET ISSUE)  
VALID  
VOID ITEM  
WASTE  
TABLE 2  
WLU  
TABLE 3  
X/TIME  
TABLE 4  
YES/NO  
ANALYSIS2  
TAX EXEMPT  
TAX SHIFT1  
TAX SHIFT2  
TAX SHIFT3  
TAX SHIFT4  
TAX SHIFT5  
TAX SHIFT6  
PARK ORDER  
SERVE ORDER  
KP ROUTING  
SPLIT CHECK  
NEW CHECK1  
NEW CHECK2  
NEW CHECK3  
NEW CHECK4  
107  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
NUMERIC 1  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 2  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 3  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 4  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 5  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 6  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 7  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 8  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 9  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 00  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
NUMERIC 000  
Used to reposition the numeric keypad anywhere on the keyboard  
ADD CHECK  
Used to add multiple guest checks (soft checks) for payment together or to add check between different tracking  
files. or to move one check to another.  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
108  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
BACK SPACE  
Used to program the alpha BACKSPACE function key  
CANCEL  
Press the cancel to abort a transaction in progress. All current items are removed (voided)  
HALO (0:NO LIMIT)  
This is the maximum sale amount for this key  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
This forces validation if a cancel is carried out (only on printer  
models with a validation option)  
PRINT RECEIPT  
This controls whether cancelled transactions will be printed.  
CAPS  
Used to program the alpha programming CAPTIAL Letters lock function key  
CASH  
Used to finalise or tender cash sales. Change is computed when the amount of the cash tender is greater than the  
amount of the sale. The optional system flag can be set allow change calculation on a sales is finaliesed using the  
post tender system flag  
HALO (0:NO LIMIT)  
EXEMPT TAX  
OPEN DRAWER  
This is the maximum sale amount for this key  
This allows each tax rate to be excluded from the sale calculation  
This controls whether the cash drawer will open.  
This forces validation if a cancel is carried out (only on printer  
models with a validation option)  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
AMOUNT TENDER COMPULSORY  
DISABLE UNDER TENDERING  
This forces the entry of moneys given for change  
This prohibits partial tender i.e. Value lower than sale  
ALLOW UNDER TENDER IN X ONLY This forces use of X Manager mode for partial tender  
COIN CHANGE PORT# (0-7)  
Mainly for the US market this allows an automated coin changer  
TIP DECLARE  
This is used for the declaration of tips earned by employees  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
This forces validation if a cancel is carried out (only on printer  
models with a validation option)  
SLIP  
Used to print guest check bills to a loose-leaf paper printer  
PRINT CHECK ON PRINTER# (0 – 40) This determines which printer from the systems printer list will be  
used for bills  
PRINT CHECK AUTOMATICALLY  
SERVICE CHECK  
This will automatically close the check after printing  
PRINT CONSEC# ON GUEST CHECK This will determine if the receipt consecutive number is printed on  
the bill  
109  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
CHEQUE  
Use this key to finalise or tender cheque sales. Change is computed when the amount of the cheque tender is  
greater than the amount of the sale, for cash back etc…  
HALO (0:NO LIMIT)  
EXEMPT TAX  
OPEN DRAWER  
This is the maximum sale amount for this key  
This allows each tax rate to be excluded from the sale calculation  
This controls whether the cash drawer will open.  
This forces validation if a cancel is carried out (only on printer  
models with a validation option)  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
COMPULSORY CHEQUE ENDORSE This forces endorsement printing onto a check (only on printer  
models with a validation option)  
AMOUNT TENDER COMPULSORY  
DISABLE UNDER TENDERING  
This forces the entry of moneys given for change  
This prohibits partial tender i.e. Value lower than sale  
ALLOW UNDER TENDER IN X ONLY This forces use of X Manager mode for partial tender  
NON-ADD# ENTRY COMPULSORY  
HALO : Y=CHANGE/N=TENDER  
This forces the operator to enter a reference number  
The maximum value can apply either to the sale amount tendered or  
to the change given  
COIN CHANGE PORT# (0-7)  
Mainly for the US market this allows an automated coin changer  
CHEQUE CASHING  
Use the Cheque Cashing key to exchange a cheque for cash outside of a sale.  
HALO (0:NO LIMIT)  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This is the maximum sale amount for this key  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
ALLOW HALO OVERRIDE IN X ONLY This forces the use of X Manager mode to override the  
maximum value  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
This forces validation if a cancel is carried out (only on printer  
models with a validation option)  
CHK ENDORSEMENT  
This will print onto the check an endorsement message (only on printer models with a validation sensor)  
PRINTING PORT# (0 –7)  
This is the physical port that the printer is connected  
CLEAR  
Press CLEAR to clear numeric entries or error conditions  
CONTINUE  
Used in-conjunction with the magnetic card swipe system  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
110  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CURR.CONV 1 - 5  
Used to convert and display the value of the transaction in foreign currency. This works also for Euro dual  
totalling in-conjunction with system printing flags. It is assumed currency rate one is the Euro rate  
RATE  
This is the current exchange rate  
CHANGE IN FOREIGN CURRENCY This determines whether change is given in the local currency or in  
the same currency by as the sale was paid.  
LINKED DRAWER # (0 - 3)  
This is the cash drawer, which is to be opened  
CURSOR DOWN  
Use the cursor control keys to program the position of the cursor on the screen  
CURSOR UP  
Use the cursor control keys to program the position of the cursor on the screen  
CURSOR LEFT  
Use the cursor control keys to program the position of the cursor on the screen  
CURSOR RIGHT  
Use the cursor control keys to program the position of the cursor on the screen  
DECIMAL  
Use the decimal key to enter fractional rates or percentages. Do not use to enter amounts.  
DELETE  
Used to program the alpha programming DELETE function key.  
DONE  
Press DONE to exit a WLU screen when multiple entries are allowed on the WLU. This key is a required  
program can and should not be omitted from the keyboard. This key also acts as a backspace when programming  
alpha  
ANALYSIS 3  
This key is used to record sales totals providing analysis on the both the financial report and special hourly sales  
analysis report. The default text can be changed providing sales analysis for any category. This key can also be  
programmed to switch the printing area of kitchen orders.  
EXEMPT TAX  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
This allows each tax rate to be excluded from the calculation  
This forces validation if a cancel is carried out (only on printers  
with validation)  
KP PERIOD OVERRIDE  
This changes the area in which the item is printed from the normal  
programmed route to one of the 4 pre-programmed kitchen printer  
periods  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
111  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ANALYSIS 1  
This key is used to record sales totals providing analysis on the both the financial report and special hourly sales  
analysis report. The default text can be changed providing sales analysis for any category. This key can also be  
programmed to switch the printing area of kitchen orders.  
EXEMPT TAX  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
This allows each tax rate to be excluded from the sale calculation  
This forces validation if a cancel is carried out (only on printers  
with validation)  
KP PERIOD OVERRIDE  
This changes the area in which the item is printed from the normal  
programmed route to one of the 4 pre-programmed printer periods  
EMPLOYEE # (CASHIER)  
The employee number key is used to sign on a cashier, clerk, server or employee who is starting registration. This  
is used for CLERK CODE entry.  
EMPLOYEE 1 - 10  
The employee key can be programmed to sign on a specific cashier when pressed directly without entering a  
code, the employee 1 - 10 keys can be used for this purpose. These keys are used for PUSH Button clerk entry.  
The employee number to be allocated to this key is set in P-Mode, system options programming  
ERR CORRECT  
Press error correct immediately after an item to remove that item from the sale total. This key also acts as a delete  
key when programming items to a Window Look Up.  
HALO (0:NO LIMIT)  
This is the maximum sale amount for this key  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
This forces validation if a cancel is carried out (only valid printers)  
FD STAMP SHIFT  
Press FD STAMP SHIFT to shift the pre-programmed food voucher status of an item prior to its sale  
FD STAMP SUBTL  
Press FD STMP SUBTTL to display the total of food stamp voucher eligible items in the current sale  
FD STAMP TENDER  
Use the FD STMP TENDER key to tender Food Stamp vouchers after the display of the food stamp eligible  
subtotal. Depending upon function key programming, change less than £1 can be applied to any cash balance or  
issued as cash change.  
HALO (0:NO LIMIT)  
EXEMPT TAX  
OPEN DRAWER  
ALLOW DECIMAL ENTRY  
FOOD STAMP CHANGE:  
Y=CASH/N=FOOD STAMP  
This is the maximum sale amount for this key  
This allows each tax rate to be excluded from the calculation  
This is the cash drawer, which is to be opened  
This allows decimal as well as integer values  
Change can be given either in cash or in stamps  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
GUEST #  
112  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Used to record the number of guests served by a transaction. The entry may be compulsory, the entry can also be  
programmed to appear on printers  
COMP AFTER BEGINNING OF CHECK This forces guest entry when a check is opened  
COMPULSORY FOR ALL SALES  
PRINT ON KP (Kitchen Printer)  
This forces guest entry at all times  
This prints the number of guests on kitchen order  
HOLD  
Used to identify an individual item, or an entire transaction, in order that the selected items will not print/display  
on the kitchen printer / KVS when the transaction is finalised. The system can be programmed to warn if items  
are held when a check is stored, also to automatic select ready print when a check is recalled.  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
INACTIVE  
The inactive function key can be re-used as many times as necessary to inactivate key locations  
KEYBOARD LEVEL 1 - 5  
Use to select one of the five keyboard levels, Menu levels can be automatically changed at specific times, on  
specific days.  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
LIST CHECK 1 - 4  
Press the List Check key to display a list of open checks.  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
MACRO OFF  
This switches the macro during the pre-programmed key sequence to the Off-mode position. This key is not  
required on the keyboard as it is used only during macro programming  
MACRO P  
This switches the macro during the pre-programmed key sequence to the P-mode position. This key is not  
required on the keyboard as it is used only during macro programming  
MACRO PAUSE  
Used to indicate a pause in the macro, allowing greater user choice for the display and operation of macros one  
pause per required key press is programmed.  
MACRO R  
This switches the macro during the pre-programmed key sequence to the Register mode position. This key is not  
required on the keyboard an is used only during macro programming  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
MACRO S  
113  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This switches the macro during the pre-programmed key sequence to the S-mode position. This key is not  
required on the keyboard as it is used only during macro programming  
MACRO SET  
This key is used in REG as a method of programming macros by recording the key strokes as they are entered.  
By pressing the MACRO SET key carrying out the require mode changes, key strokes etc then pressing the  
MACRO1-40 key to finalise the sequences to that key.  
MACRO VOID  
This switches the macro during the pre-programmed key sequence to the Void-mode position. This key is not  
required on the keyboard as it is used only during macro programming  
MACRO X  
This switches the macro during the pre-programmed key sequence to the X-mode position. This key is not  
required on the keyboard as it is used only during macro programming  
MACRO Z  
This switches the macro during the pre-programmed key sequence to the Z-mode position. This key is not  
required on the keyboard as it is used only during macro programming  
MACRO 1 - 40  
Used to execute one of the forty possible pre-programmed key sequences, by allocating the required key to the  
keyboard and then programming the appropriate sequence  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
The macro key sequence is also programmed here if it has not been programmed using a  
MACRO SET key  
MACRO #  
Used to execute one of forty possible macros by entering the macro number and pressing the macro code entry  
key macros can also be included within a WLU key list for menu selection of an option.  
MDSE RETURN  
Use to remove items from the sales totals within or outside of a transaction  
HALO (0:NO LIMIT)  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
This is the maximum sale amount for this key  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
This forces validation if a cancel is carried out (only on printer  
models with a validation option)  
ADD TO NET GRAND TOTAL  
This adds instead of subtracting to the grand totals  
SKIP ADJUSTMENT OF PLU TOTAL The key as standard subtracts the refunded items from the  
PLU totals this prevents that happening  
114  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
MISC TEND 1 - 16  
Use a MISC TEND key to finalise or tender sales paid by various charges or other media. Tendering may or may  
not be allowed depending upon programming, over tendering is possible providing a credit card cash back  
feature.  
HALO (0:NO LIMIT)  
EXEMPT TAX  
OPEN DRAWER  
This is the maximum sale amount for this key  
This allows each tax rate to be excluded from the sale calculation  
This controls whether the cash drawer will open.  
This forces validation if a cancel is carried out (only on printer  
models with a validation option)  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
AMOUNT TENDER COMPULSORY  
DISABLE UNDER TENDERING  
This forces the entry of moneys given for change  
This prohibits partial tender i.e. Value below sale  
ALLOW UNDER TENDER IN X ONLY This forces the X Manager mode for partial tendering  
NON-ADD# ENTRY COMPULSORY  
ALLOW OVER TENDER  
This forces the operator to enter a reference number  
This allows an amount greater than the sales total  
To be tendered. This can be used to given change or for the cash  
back feature  
COIN CHANGE PORT# (0-7)  
CONNECT EFT TERMINAL  
Mainly for the US market this allows an automated coin changer  
This allows connection of an authorised Electronic  
Fund transfer terminal (credit card terminal)  
This is the function key used for download of EFT  
TRANSACTION KEY 1= CHEQ 2=CARD  
EFT TRANSACTION KEY (0-9)  
MISC TEND #  
Used to access by code any one of the 16 MISC TEND keys used to finalise or tender sales paid by various  
charges or other media. Tendering may or may not be allowed depending upon programming  
MODIFIER 1 - 10  
Preceding a PLU entry a modifier key changes one digit of the PLU number, causing a different PLU to be  
registered. MODIFIER Keys can be set to change either the item code or the description only. This can be used  
to be build up a code number system with various modifiers working together to sell a complied code. For  
example if MODIFIER 1 is set to change the 4th digit of the PLU by 4 and MODIFIER 2 is set to change the 3rd  
digit by 5 pressing MODIFIER 1 then MODIFIER 2 followed by PLU 1 would sell code 4501 PLU 2 would  
become 4502 etc.. There are relevant system options which can be change to control how modifier keys operate.  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
This changes the description of the product but not the code  
The modifier key description is prevented from being printed  
on a check tracking bill  
MODIFY DESCRIPTOR ONLY  
PRINT DESCRIPTOR ON  
GUEST CHECK  
PRINT DESCRIPTOR ON  
RECEIPT  
The modifier key description is prevented from being printed  
on the customer transaction receipt.  
AFFECT DIGIT 1-18 OF PLU#  
The digits of the PLU code can be modified by the next field  
VALUE OF AFFECTED DIGIT (0 - 9) This is the number 0-9 by which the selected digit is to be  
OF PLU Changed i.e. 3 affected by value 2 means 1 = 201, 2 = 202  
115  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
NEXT RECORD  
Used to program the next record key, used during programming to move through the program records.  
#/NOSALE  
Used to enter a non-adding memo number during a transaction, or used to open the cash drawer outside of a sale  
HALO DIGITS FOR NON-ADD ENTRY This is the maximum digits for the reference number.  
ALLOW NOSALE FUNCTION  
ALLOW NON-ADD FUNCTION  
NOSALE IN X ONLY  
NOSALE INACTIVE AFTER  
NON-ADD ENTRY  
This will enable the operator to open the cash drawer  
This will enable the operator to enter a reference number  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
Once a reference has been entered it its not  
possible to continue by just opening the drawer, a sale is required.  
COMPULSORY VALID ON NOSALE This forces validation if a cancel is done (only on valid printers)  
ENFORCE NON-ADD AT  
BEGINNING OF SALE  
COMP. NON-ADD# MUST MATCH  
HALO DIGIT#  
This forces the operator to enter a reference number before  
commencing a sale  
The halo is no longer a maximum but a compulsory criteria  
i.e. 6 becomes not digit 1 to 6 but fixed to 6 digits  
P/BAL  
Enter an amount, then press the manual previous balance (P/bal) key to use the simplest form of charge posting /  
Table Service. The P/bal key may be used any time, within a transaction. Transactions where the P/Bal key is  
used must be finalised with the service key  
MUST BE ENTERED AT START OF SALE  
COMPULSORY P/BAL  
This forces an opening balance at start of a sale  
This forces an entry of balance during a sale.  
PAGE DOWN  
This key switches between pages on the register display. Used in Window Look Ups etc.  
PAGE UP  
This key switches between pages on the register display. Used in Window Look Ups etc.  
PAID OUT 1 - 5  
Press a Paid Out key to remove moneys from the drawer  
HALO (0:NO LIMIT)  
This is the maximum sale amount for this key  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
This forces validation on this key (only on valid printers)  
PAID RECALL  
The paid recall key is used to recall the last number of transactions, where the number of transaction is  
determined in the memory allocation. The RECEIPT key can be used to issue copy receipt of past transactions.  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
116  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
%1 - %10  
Ten discount/Premium keys are available to handle various types of discounts, mark-downs and adjustments to  
items or transactions.  
HALO / RATE  
For open keys this is the maximum amount, for fixed percent items  
It is the rate to be applied  
TAXABLE by RATE 1 - 6  
FUNCTION IS INACTIVE  
The discount/premium amount can be included within the tax  
This allows the items to be prohibited without the necessity to make  
the key inactive  
FUNCTION IS ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
FUNCTION IS SALE / ITEM  
This forces use of the X Manager Mode for operation  
This determines whether the function must be applied to each item  
or to the whole sale total after subtotal.  
FUNCTION IS AMOUNT / PERCENT This determines whether the function will apply either a monetary or  
a percent adjustment.  
FUNCTION IS PLUS / MINUS  
This determines whether the adjustment will be applied as either a  
discount or addition.  
FUNCTION IS OPEN / PRESET  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
ALLOW PRESET OVERRIDE  
This determines the adjustment i.ea pre-set rate or manual  
This forces validation (only on valid printers)  
This enables the operator to manually enter an adjustment even  
when there is a pre-programmed rate  
PRESET OVERRIDE IN X ONLY  
FUNCTION NETS ITEM TOTAL  
This forces use of the X Manager Mode when it is necessary  
override the pre-programmed amount.  
This reports the values inclusive of the adjustment  
I.e. 1.00 – 10% would report 90p  
FUNCTION IS FOOD STAMP ELIGIBLEThis is for the US Market it ensures the discount is considered  
when selling food stamp products.  
ALLOW MULTIPLE SALE COUPONS This enables more than one coupon operation per sale.  
ALLOW ONLY ONE DISCOUNT  
PER TRANS  
This restricts the operation of discount /premium added at  
subtotal  
KEY IS “DO IT” DISCOUNT FUNCTIONThis operates a sale rounding system not used within the UK.  
For example If a Sale if made for 7.20 and DO IT FUNCTION set  
The sale value will be taken as 7.00 – the % cutting off the 0.20  
PLU  
Used to sell an item using the products code number rather than pressing a PLU key on the keyboard.  
PREVIOUS RECORD  
Used to reposition the previous record key, which is used during programming to move through the  
program records.  
PRICE INQUIRE  
Used to inquire on the retail price of a product this can be for single item or multiple products  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
STAY DOWN/POP UP  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
Price inquiry for Single item or for multiple items  
117  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
PRICE LEVEL 1 - 20  
Press a price level key prior to a PLU entry to shift the price of a PLU to a different ‘price set’ pre-programmed  
to the PLU. Each product has the ability to sell at five different prices. The prices are not fixed however at price  
levels 1 through to five. The Price level can be allocated from any of the twenty to provide detailed price  
reporting using the PLU by price level report (if set in memory allocation). The norm for a bar is two prices  
normal and special offer price this requires no special programming. The terminal however can be programmed  
to used up to twenty price bands. For example we could have some PLUs using prices 1 – 5 representing sizes  
and some PLUs using prices 6 – 10. This would then representing different products types sold at different sizes;  
pressing the appropriate price key will sell the correct size. Then using the price level report, the analysis would  
show the total per product a breakdown of the price sales per product and an overall sales total for all products  
per price level  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
PRINT  
This key is used to temporarily change the remote printer settings of a PLU allowing printing to the programmed  
printer route. This key is required on the keyboard if the PLU auto grill feature is to be used.  
OUTPUT PRINTER # (0-40)  
This is the printer number to which the items are printed.  
PRINT CHECK  
Used to print a bill for any of the check tracking files 1 - 4  
PRINT CHECK ON PRINTER # (0-40) This is the printer number which will print the check bill.  
PRINT CHECK AUTOMATICALLY  
SERVICE CHECK  
This will ensure no manual operation of the print check key is  
required. The check is held after the bill is printed.  
PRINT CONSEC# ON GUEST CHECK This enables the receipt number to be printed on bill  
PRINT HOLD  
Used to remove the HOLD designation from an item or order, so that the items and their instructions are sent to  
the kitchen printer/KVS at finalisation, check hold  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
PROMO  
Press the PROMO key to void the price (the item remains). This can be used in 2 for 1 promotions. A promo  
count is available for each item  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
TAXABLE by RATE 1 - 6  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
The amount can be included within the tax calculation, relevant if  
VAT is to be added, to prevent the from being required as a  
payment.  
PRINT SCREEN  
Press the print screen key to print a copy of the current screen on the designated receipt printer  
QUIT  
Press QUIT to automatically sign on/off the current cashier/clerk, using the magnetic card swipe reader.  
118  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
RECEIPT ON /OFF  
This is used to turn the receipt off, The receipt can be programmed using system flags to be a continuous receipt  
with post receipt, or to print only when the post receipt key is pressed.  
RECALL CHECK 1 - 4  
The Check Tracking System can maintain only balances (hard checks) or entire transactions (soft checks) in the  
registers memory. Four different tracking files can be separated to maintain different information for example,  
restaurant checks, call-in orders, delivery orders, and or table balances. The check number can be entered by the  
operator or calculated automatically by the system  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
ENFORCE SEAT#  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
This makes it compulsory to enter the seat of each person at the  
table so that if required at finalisation seat separation and split  
payment can be carried out.  
TABLE ENTRY REQUIRED  
MULTIPLE CHECKS ALLOWED  
FOR EACH TABLE  
This force the operator to enter a table number  
The table number can also be used to recall open checks.  
Allows the user to have more than one check at each table.  
GUEST COUNT ENTRY REQUIRED This requests the input of guests when a check is opened  
COMPULSORY FOR ALL SALES  
ASSIGNED BY REGISTER  
This forces the operator to enter a check for every sale  
The system can work on manually entered check number, or can  
generate it’s own sequential number  
OPENING EMPLOYEE HAS  
EXCLUSIVE ACCESS  
The check can be restricted in operation solely to the  
employee that started the sale.  
PRINT CHECK# ON RECEIPT  
PRINT CHECK# ON JOURNAL  
PRINT CHECK# ON KP  
This allows the check number from printing on the receipt  
This allows the check number from printing on the audit  
This allows the check number from printing on the order  
The sale is made and stored and the check number is automatically  
generated, pressing the check key recalls the oldest check ready for  
finalisation. This can be overwritten by manually entering the check  
The sale details can be printed automatically when stored  
This forces use of the New Check key for sales to a check that does  
Not already exist. (the New Check key follows the status of the this  
key)  
AUTO CHECK MANAGEMENT  
PRINT ON CHECK AUTOMATICALLY  
DISABLE OPEN A NEW CHECK  
LENGTH OF CHECK# IN DIGITS(0 -10)The check can have an enforced number of digits.  
RECD ACCT 1 - 5  
Press a RECD ACCT key to add cash, check or miscellaneous media to the drawer  
HALO (0:NO LIMIT)  
This is the maximum sale amount for this key  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
This forces validation if a cancel is done (only on valid printers)  
RECEIPT  
Press this key to issue a transaction receipt at the designated receipt printer  
119  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
REPEAT  
Use the repeat key to quickly re-order a set of items. When a check is recalled  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
SCALE  
Use the scale key r to manually enter a weight for extension.  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
ALLOW MANUAL ENTRY OF WEIGHT  
Weight can either be entered manually or on a scale  
INHIBIT TARE WEIGHT ENTRY  
TARE ENTRY IN X ONLY  
TARE ENTRY IS COMPULSORY  
WEIGHT SYMBOL  
The system will allow the tare weight management  
This force the use of X Manager mode for this operation  
This forces the operator to use the tare weight method.  
This allows for either pounds or kilo entry.  
SET TARE WEIGHT  
This access a sub menu for tare weight programming  
SEAT#  
Used to identify a specific seat (or person) within a transaction. Facilitates separate payment by seat from a single  
check and identifies to the food preparation staff (through KPs and KVs) how to assemble meals.  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
SHIFT  
Used to program the alpha programming Shift capital Letters lock function key  
SPLIT ITEM  
When like items are consolidated in a transaction. You can move the cursor to the item and press the SPLIT  
ITEM key to display the items separately, instead of in consolidated form. Used in-conjunction with the SEAT  
key  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
SPLIT PAYMENT  
Use the split payment key to divide the amount of a guest check into equal segments for payment and issue bills  
accordingly. To pay bills using the split payment method, recall the guest check press the sutotal key then enter  
the numer of people by which the bill is to be split then press the split payment key to activate the display of  
balances due for payment for each person.  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
STOCK INQUIRY  
Used to display the current stock situation for a PLU, this will display the total for all the registers  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
Y=STAY DOWN/N=POP UP  
If set to stay down the terminal will stay in price inquire mode  
120  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
STORE CHECK 1 - 4  
The check tracking system can maintain only balances (hard check) or entire transactions (soft check) in the  
register memory. Four different tracking files can be separately maintained. For example, restaurant checks, call-  
in orders, delivery orders, and/or table balance. Press one of the four STORE CHECK # keys to finalise a  
tracking transaction  
HALO (0:NO LIMIT)  
For open keys this is the maximum amount, for fixed percent items  
It is the rate to be applied  
EXEMPT TAX  
This allows each tax rate to be excluded from the sale  
calculation  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
This forces validation if a cancel is carried out (only on a printer  
with a validation sensor)  
NON-ADD# COMPULSORY  
PRINT ON RECEIPT  
This forces the entry of a reference number using #/Nosale  
This allows the function description printing  
PRINT ON JOURNAL  
This allows the function description printing  
SERVICE OF NEGATIVE  
BALANCE IN X ONLY  
HARD CHECK PRINTER # (0 - 40)  
This forces the operator to use the X manager mode  
storage of checks, which have a minus sale total.  
This is printer number which the check will print to when using this  
key for balance on tracking, when NON detailed / Hard check  
tracking is used, the print check key will print the detailed bill.  
This allows store of a sale onto a sequential check number without  
having to initially open the check.  
AUTO CHECK MANAGEMENT  
SUBTOTAL  
Used to display the balance due.  
TABLE 1 - 4  
This is used for reference as to which table a check is related to, there can be numerous checks per table,  
depending upon, the programming of the store check key. Checks can also be recalled using the table number.  
ANALYSIS 2  
This key is used to record sales totals providing analysis on the both the financial report and special hourly sales  
analysis report. The default text can be changed providing sales analysis for any category. This key can also be  
programmed to switch the printing area of kitchen orders.  
EXEMPT TAX  
This allows each tax rate to be excluded from the sale  
calculation  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
KP PERIOD OVERRIDE  
This forces validation if a cancel is carried out (only on printers  
with validation)  
This changes the area in which the item is printed from the normal  
programmed route to one of the 4 pre-programmed printer periods  
121  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
TAX EXEMPT  
The Tax Exempt can be programmed to exempt specific taxes from a sale.  
HALO (0:NO LIMIT)  
EXEMPT TAX  
NON-ADD# COMPULSORY  
This is the maximum sale amount for this key  
Each Tax rate can be excluded for the calculation  
This forces the entry of a reference number using the  
#/no sale  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
This forces validation if a cancel is carried out (only on printer  
models with a validation option)  
TAX SHIFT 1 - 6  
These are used to change temporarily the pre-programmed tax rate of a product.  
TIME IN/OUT (CLOCK IN/OUT)  
Enter the employee clock in code then press the key to record start and end work times, breaks etc. Hours are  
maintained by the time clock system. There are various analysis reports for labour costing analysis to assist with  
management of this feature.  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
This forces validation if a cancel is ied outmode (only on nter on  
printeration if a cancel is carr  
TIP 1 - 3  
Used to enter a tip amount on a check tracking bill  
HALO (0:NO LIMIT)  
This is the maximum sale amount for this key  
TIP : Y=PERCENTAGE / N=AMOUNT This determines whether the value entered is to be  
lapplied as a monetary amount or a percentage  
TAXABLE by RATE 1 - 6  
MUST BE PAID BY MISC TEND  
AFTER TIP  
The can be included within the tax calculation  
This forces finalisation on a miscellaneous tender key  
once a tip entry has been made.  
TIP AMOUNTS ADD TO  
NET & GROSS TOTALS  
CHARGE TIP IS DEDUCTED  
FROM CASH  
The tip amount can be added into financial totals,  
this includes the moneys in the sales totals.  
The tip can be applied as a cash financial total, the  
value is then subtracted from the cash totalisers.  
TRAY SUBTOTAL (TICKET ISSUANCE)  
This key provides excellent flexibility of receipt issuance, it can be used, admission tickets, The sale is entered as  
normal in register when a receipt is receipt is required this key is pressed and a receipt for all items sold to that  
point is issued. The sale is continued and again this key is pressed issued a receipt for all items sold in the 2nd part  
of the sale a final payment receipt can then be issued at finalisation  
EXEMPT TAX  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
COMPULSORY BEFORE TENDER  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
ADVANCE CONSEC# AT FINAL  
TENDER ONLY  
Each Tax rate can be excluded for the calculation  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
This forces use of this key to display total sale value  
This forces validation if a cancel is done (only on valid printers)  
Each receipt issued can have a consecutive number or each  
can have the same number.  
122  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUNCTION KEY - DEFINITIONS  
TRANSFER CHECK 1 - 4  
Used to transfer one or all open soft checks from one server to another. A transfer check receipt will print.  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
VALIDATE  
Use this key to initiate a single line validation (a printer with validation capability is required in the system)  
WASTE  
Used to start and end entries of items that are wasted. A waste count is maintained for each item and the  
inventory is adjusted.  
ACTIVE IN X ONLY  
COMPULSORY VALIDATION  
This forces the use of X Manager Mode for this key  
This forces validation if a cancel is carried out (only on printer  
models with a validation option)  
AFFECT ON PROJECTIONS  
Are the wastage values to be included in the product mix group  
usage.  
WLU #  
Used to access window look up menus by their code number or to allocate a WLU one touch button to the  
keyboard  
X/TIME  
Used for multiplication and split pricing  
ALLOW SPLIT PRICING  
This allows entry of fraction quantities i.e. 1 x/time3 x/time - will  
result in a 3rdof the items quantity and value being sold i.e. 1.00 sold  
@ 1/3 is 33.333  
YES/NO  
Used to answer programming and operation questions  
NEW CHECK 1 – 4  
The standard recall check key, allows a check to be opened if it does not already exist. This is excellent in  
hospitality tracking, however for account management credit may not so readily be given. When this button is  
programmed accounts are not opened automatically. A warning will indicate an account does not exist if an  
attempt is made to open using the recall check The new check button is used to open any new accounts. The  
programmability for this key is automatically picked up from the status of the Recall check key.  
NOFOUND PLU (NOT FOUND PLU)  
If a code is entered or scanned that does not exist It is then possible using this key to create that item.  
PRICE CHANGE  
This allows the price of an item to be changed. This can have prohibited or restricted allocated to the PLU.  
123  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                 
                                                                 
                                                                 
                                                                 
SYSTEM OPTIONS  
Options are sorted by category to assist the programmer in finding a specific option.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. PLU  
2. PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. GROUP  
4. FUNCTION KEY  
5. SYSTEM OPTION  
6. TAXES  
7. MESSAGES  
8. WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
9. TIME PERIOD  
10. EMPLOYEE  
11. AUTHORITY LEVEL  
12. PRINTER TABLES & KV ROUTING  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
SYSTEM OPTION PROGRAMMING  
L1  
1. GENERAL FUNCTION OPTIONS  
2. TAX OPTIONS  
3. CASH DRAWER OPTIONS  
4. TRAINING MODE OPTIONS  
5. LEVEL/MODIFIER OPTIONS  
6. TRACKING FILE OPTIONS  
7. KITCHEN PRINTING/VIDEO OPTIONS  
8. VALIDATION /SUBTOTAL PRT OPTIONS  
9. GENERAL PRINTING OPTIONS  
10. REPORT PRINTING OPTIONS  
11. REPORT OPTIONS  
12. TIME KEEPING OPTIONS  
!
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
124  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
GENERAL FUNCTION OPTIONS  
MANAGER CONTROL IN X-MODE  
Negative Sales  
This prevents minus priced products being sold in the register position. Manager access of the X mode is  
required to continue the sale.  
Negative Tender  
This prevents transaction which are a minus value being finalised in the register position. Manager access of the  
X mode is required to finalise the sale.  
Zero Sales  
This prevents zero priced products being sold in the register position. Manager access of the X mode is required  
to continue the sale.  
ENFORCE ANALYSIS 1,2,3:  
At Begin of Sale.  
This makes it compulsory to press one of the three totalisers keys at the beginning of a sale. When using the  
analsysis keys to compulsory change the printing to kitchen periods the analysis key would be forced at the  
beginning of the sale  
Before Tender  
This makes it compulsory to press one of the three totalisers keys at the end of a sale.  
DEFAULT DESTINATION  
This enables the most common of the three types of sales totalisers to be set as standard. It is possible to press  
either of the two alternative keys to switch the sales totals to another area.  
ROUNDING ON %  
It is assumed as standard when a minus/premium calculation is carried out rounding with round up/off at the 3rd  
decimal place. This can be changed to round either down or off at the 3rd decimal.  
ROUNDING ON SPLIT PRICE / DECIMAL MULTIPLICATION.  
This allows entry of fraction quantities i.e. 1 @/for 3 @/for - will result in a 3rd of the items quantity and value  
being sold i.e. 1.00 sold @ 1/3 is 33.333 It is assumed round up/off at the 3rd decimal place. This can be changed  
to round either down or off at the 3rd decimal.  
CONSOLIDATE LIKE ITEMS  
This combines items together i.e. 2 of PLU 1 would print PLU1, PLU 1 with this flag set it is 2 x PLU1  
HASH OPTIONS  
When a product is set as HASH this means all totalisers for this product are not to be treated in the normal  
manner, i.e. added to gross, net etc. The Hash PLU can be added to various totalisers  
ACTIVATE ROUNDING ON CASH  
125  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Design for the European market used to activate total rounding  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
GENERAL FUNCTION OPTIONS  
ACTIVATE ROUNDING ON SUBTOTAL  
Design for the European market used to activate total rounding  
GLOBAL ENTRY LIMIT  
This forces the system to only accept the number of digits entered here i.e. 4 digit means only 99.99 can ever be  
made as a sale. However remember that if you require a maximum of 99.99 sale it would be better to Enter 5  
digits as to tender would require 100.00  
DIRECT MULTIPLICATION  
Under normal circumstances a value which is entered then proceeded by a product is assumed to be a price entry.  
However with this flag on it is assumed to be a quantity this in turn eliminates the need for the x/time key. For  
example to sell 5 of product 1 you would not use 5 x/time product 1 but simple 5 product 1. This applies to preset  
items only.  
Maximum Digit (1-5)  
This is the maximum digits that can be entered for a qunatity multiplication.  
ALLOW PLU PRESET/HALO OVERRIDE  
This when disabled prevents any product being sold as a manual price override of a pre-programmed price. This  
is a general setting, taking priority other program restrictions that may be in place for the products.  
SILENT KEY DEPRESSION  
This prevents the system for making a key beep when a button is pressed.  
ALPHA CODE ENTRY  
This determines whether characters entered on the system will be through character codes or using then pre-  
programmed alpha layout.  
ALLOW OPEN ENTRY FOR SCALE PLUS  
This determines whether scaleable PLUs are to enter weight automatically from a linked scale or using a manual  
entry of weight onto the SCALE key.  
DEACTIVATE VOID MODE  
This is a security feature to disallow completely the void mode on this terminal.  
DISABLE DATE/TIME PROGRAMMING  
This is a security feature to disallow the date and time change within the x mode. However if there are some  
requirements for this programming on the terminal the AUTHORITY PROGRAMMING provides an alternative  
way of restricting access.  
126  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
GENERAL FUNCTION OPTIONS  
ALLOW PLU COPY BY RANGE  
The program menu option copy program, allows various details to be copied from one to another such as  
keyboards, WLUs for PLUs the copy paramaters can be set so that a product is copied to another product or to a  
range or items.  
ALLOW POST TENDERING  
This allows the recalculation of change for the last sale, by entering the value and pressing Cash  
EMPLOYEE POP UP/STAY DOWN  
This determines whether an employee remains signed onto the terminal when a sale is completed, this is referred  
to as stay down. The alternative is pop up which means as soon as a sale is finalised the employee is signed off  
forcing an employee code to be entered every transaction.  
EMPLOYEE SIGN ON  
The employees can be signed onto the terminal in various ways. The most common method is to allocate  
employee buttons these will sign on staff. Alternatively, they can use an employee code button. This allows you  
to use either the EMPLOYEE number which is the default sequential code or the OPERATING CODE which is a  
unique code programmed per employee.  
QTY LIMIT FOR X/TIME KEY  
No multiplication quantity will be accepted which exceeds the value entered here.  
EMPLOYEE # LINKED CODE (1- 10)  
Ten push button employee sign on keys can be programmed to the keyboard they can be used to sign on any  
employee with the system. The employee’s sequential number is allocated here. This enables that employee to be  
signed on at the press of a button.  
AUTO CLEAR ERROR CONDITION  
If set to Yes, error conditions will clear automatically after a momentary error tone displaying an error  
GUEST CHECK BALANCE HALO (0=NO LIMIT)  
The sales value which can be stored against a tracking value can be restricted to a maximum limit, this can be  
programmed here for all tracking files 1 – 4 or against each individual store check key. The HALO message will  
appear to warn the operator the maximum balance has been achieved.  
SET DEFAULT SEAT# TO 1  
The System can be programmed to enable individual seat allocation per guest for each tracking file.  
This allows each person to pay, their share of the overall bill. A total will be calculated for each seat  
127  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
allocated to items on a tracking bill. Normally seat numbers are entered when required, this option will  
automatically allocate each person seat number 1.  
128  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
GENERAL FUNCTION OPTIONS  
CONTINUE MACRO WHEN MACRO IS LOOP  
This prevents macros from running in a continueous sequence.  
ENTER TIME FOR TRANSACTION VOID  
The option to enter the time for voids, is used to ensure that reporting by time periods are correct this is an  
optional feature for those wishing to manage hourly sales for analysis purposes. This would ensure a void for a  
sale made at a specific time can be done after that time yet still subtract from the correct hourly totaliser.  
START CURSOR AT PRICE 1 IN PLU PGM  
When programming PLUs the cursor normal starts at the DESCRIPTION field, this flag will set the cursors  
starting point as the price field which results in easier fast maintenance programming  
SCREEN SAVER (MINUTES)  
The display will turn off after the allocated number of minutes, a key press will be required to activate the  
display.  
ALLOW THE PRESS (NEWSPAPER)CODE PLU  
This allows the sale of the specialist newspaper barcodes which differ in format from the standard EAN 8 and 13  
digit  
ALLOW MULTIPLE MULTIPLICATION  
Note:- This feature cannot be used with SPLIT PRICING or DIRECT MULTUPLICATION.  
The quantity key will allow two entries before the sale of a product, these two entries are then multiplied  
together to give the total sales quantity for the product i.e. 5 x/time then 10 x/time = 50 items  
ALLOW TAX SHIFT BY ANLAYSIS 2  
Design for the American market to apply tax to fast food sales, the feature forces when the analysis 2  
key is pressed the tax programming of the items as standard to be ignored and the tax relating to the  
analysis key to be applied.  
TAX SHIFT ITEM POP UP/TRANS.POP UP  
When it is necessary to change the pre-programmed tax rate of an item using the tax shift key, the  
decision can then be made to allow that change to take place just for the item registered i.e. POP UP,  
or until another selection is made i.e. STAY DOWN.  
BASE CURRENCY LOCAL/EURO  
This allows the currency change to EUROs in such time when all monies will no longer be Sterling,  
Punts etc. but is always accepted as EUROs  
129  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
GENERAL FUNCTION OPTIONS  
ALLOW CLERK INTERRUPT  
This when will allow employees to lay away a sale, this enables numerous staff to operate the terminal at once.  
ALLOW FLOATING CLERK  
This allows employees to use any terminal in a multi EPS site. Commencing a sale on one machine  
and moving the sale throughout the system for additions etc as they sign onto different terminals.  
ALLOW CLERK CHANGE WITHOUT SIGN OFF  
This enables the another operator to interrupt the sale in progress without the need of the orginal  
opertor to sign off, providing a true clerk interrupt principle.  
GELDKARTE LOGIN PASSWORD  
This is a European feature not used in the UK and related to the German, EFT password.  
SKIP IN NOT FOUND PLU REGISTRATION  
This allows both the Group link and the Description to be removed from the NOT FOUND prompt  
required when creating a new product in the register position.  
SUBTRACT CHANGE FROM FOREIGN1 TOTAL  
This is design for the use of the change over period from home currency to Euros, at such time all  
home currency will taken out of ciculation and the Euros will be given as change.  
130  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
TAX OPTIONS  
TAX ROUNDING FACTOR  
It is assumed as standard that a tax calculation resulting in more than 3 decimal places will be rounded up/off.  
This can be changed to round either down or off at the 3rd decimal place.  
VAT SUBTRACTED FROM INDIVIDUAL PLU TTLS  
This system flag enables product values to be reported exclusive of the vat content.  
PRINT TAXABLE AMOUNTS ON R/J  
This prints the value of the goods to which tax is to be applied on both the receipts and journals.  
TAXABLE STATUS INDICATOR  
When an item is linked to a tax rate it is also assigned a symbol relating to the tax table This is to assist viewing  
of the tax totals on the receipts and relating them back to an individual item. It also serves as a useful check to  
ensure an item has been successfully programmed to the tax totals.  
PRINT TAX AMOUNTS AT TENDER  
This determines wether the amount of TAX charged will be printed on the receipt at finalisation.  
PRINT VAT AMOUNTS SEPARATELY  
This prints the value of the sale net of vat on the receipt.  
TAX PRINT Y=COMBINED / N=ITEMIZED  
This feature is designed to simplify the receipt issued. When products of different tax rates are sold the tax can be  
printed separately per rate this is referred to as itemised. Alternatively the total tax due of all the rates can be  
displayed and printed, this is referred to as combined.  
PRINT TAX EXEMPT DESCRIPTOR/TTLS.  
When an item is exempt from tax this can be indicated on the receipt by printing both a descriptor and the value  
of the exempt amount. Tax exemption works in conjunction with function key system flags being programmed.  
PRINT SUBTOTAL WITHOUT TAX  
When adding tax to sale total, the total can be printed without the tax total added before the tax calculations are  
printed.  
DO NOT SHOW FOOD STAMP INDICATOR  
The US market uses food coupons, This option suppresses the food stamp indicator of an individual product.  
131  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
CASH DRAWER OPTIONS  
ALLOW SALES WITH DRAWER OPEN  
This enables sales to be made even when the drawer is open  
C-I-D AMOUNT LIMIT  
When the system reaches the programmed limit the machine will warn the operator to take action and perform a  
PAID OUT sequence to reduce the CASH IN DRAWER Totaliser.  
OPEN DRAWER DURING X / Z REPORTS  
The cash drawer does not normally open when reports are taken, This system flags opens the drawer at the  
appropriate times, allowing access to the drawer  
ACTIVATE OPEN DRAWER ALARM  
This works in-conjunction with the alarm time providing a warning when the drawer is open too long.  
OPEN DRAWER ALARM TIME  
This is the time limit in seconds that the drawer can be open before the alarm activates.  
132  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
TRAINING MODE OPTIONS  
TRAINING MODE PASSWORD  
This is the password used to active and de-active the training feature. The training mode option can be found on  
the X-MODE Menu. Note if the X-mode is not to be used for activating the training for the whole machine then a  
training employee can be programmed to enable training to operate alongside normal sales.  
OPEN DRAWER IN TRAINING MODE  
The cash drawer is not normally required to open during staff training. This system flag allows for the drawer to  
open as normal.  
TRAINING EMPLOYEE FILE #  
This is the employee number used to provide the training mode employee report totalisers. If a trraining mode  
report is required, one of the employee numbers is set aside for reporting purposes this employee is then no-  
longer used in the register position, but reserved for training mode report printing, usually printed out be  
selecting reporting of an individual employee number.  
ALLOW REAR DISPLAY IN TRAINING MODE  
The rear display can be disabled, so that no sales are shown, whilst training is being carried out.  
SEND ORDERS TO KP/KV IN TRAINING  
Whilst training mode is activated, the kitchen printing is not normally required. This options actives the printing  
as normal, indicators that training is being given are used to differentiate between normal trading.  
PRINT JOURNALS IN TRAINING  
Using this system flag it is possible to enable or disable journal printing whilst training is taking place.  
PRINT RECEIPTS IN TRAINING  
Using this system flag it is possible to enable or disable receipt issuance whilst training is taking place.  
PRINT “TRAINING”  
The indicator TRAINING is displayed and printed, whilst the training mode is active to show the terminal is not  
operating in normal registration mode. This indicator can be suppressed.  
133  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
LEVEL/MODIFIER OPTIONS  
DEFAULT KEYBOARD LEVEL  
The terminal has five completely independent keyboards programmed into the system. This option determines  
which keyboard will be loaded as standard when the machine is turned on. The LEVEL SHIFT keys will be  
required to switch from this level to an alternative. Levels can also be defined in X  
KEYBOARD LEVEL Y=STAY DOWN / N=POP UP  
The switch between keyboard levels can be used in three ways. Firstly STAY DOWN, this is when the new  
keyboard level selected will remain until an alternative LEVEL SHIFT key is pressed. The second option is POP  
UP, this forces the return to the default level, when next item is sold, the third option allows the level to stay  
during one transaction before returning to the orginal setting.  
DEFAULT PRICE LEVEL  
The terminal has five prices per product where that price can be allocated from any one of twenty price  
bands.price activated for sale using a different price level key per price. This option determines which price level  
will be loaded as standard when the machine is turned on. The PRICE SHIFT keys will be required to switch  
from this level to an alternative. Default price Levels can also be defined in the X  
PRICE LEVEL Y=STAY DOWN / N=POP UP  
The switch between levels can be programmed in three ways. Firstly STAY DOWN, in this instance when a  
PRICE SHIFT key is used, the new keyboard level selected will remain until the PRICE SHIFT key is pressed.  
The second option is POP UP, this forces the price to return to the default price level, when for the next item. the  
third option allows the level to stay during one transaction before returning  
PLU MOD KEYS Y=STAY DOWN / N=POP UP  
Preceding a PLU entry a modifier key changes one digit of the PLU number, causing a different PLU to be  
registered. MODIFIER Keys can be set to change either the item code or the description only. For example to  
modifier the 3 digit of a number by 2 would be 1 = 201 1001 = 1201 etc ideal for different sizes etc i.e. PLU 1  
Pint 201 Half Pint etc.. Modifier keys can also be used for a different function. They act as text print keys,  
modify the description only of a product sold, providing instructions for products to be printed on receipts, KP  
orders etc. This option is to determine whether the effect a modifier key is to stay active until another selection is  
made. This is referred to as Stay Down. The alternative is that the change takes effect solely for that product and  
normal operation will be resumed when the next product is sold. This is called POP UP. The third option allows  
the level to stay down one transaction before returning to orginal settings.  
APPLY MODIFIER TO CODE ENTRY PLUS  
The modifier change of a PLU can be programmed for keyboard items only or keyboard and PLU code  
MODIFIER OVERWRITES PREVIOUS MODIFIER  
If Y, only the last modifier entry will affect the PLU number. Use this setting when a PLU is modified only once,  
i.e. small/med/large. If N, several modifiers affecting different digit positions could be entered then affect the  
PLU registered. For example, size, crust type, and/or toppings could be  
134  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
TRACKING FILE OPTIONS  
AUTOMATIC TRANSFER CHECK  
This refers to re-assigning a check opened by one employee to another employee. This automation allows transfer  
when an employee opens a check, or changes the operator whilst a check is open.  
CHECKS PAID SLIP IS STUB  
This produce an abrievated bill, showing only financial information only.  
PRINT GUEST CHECK  
This prevents guest bills being printed at the terminal, even if a print check key is programmed, design to  
program the terminal as a order not payment register.  
SELECT HELD ITEMS ON RECALL  
The terminal operates a system, which allows the operator to prevent items being printed in the kitchen until  
requested. This is a feature used in-conjunction with the check tracking files allowing all Held items to  
automatically be selected ready for printing the moment the check is opened. The items on hold are highlighted  
when a check is re-opened, eliminating the need to manual select each held item. The next stage pressing of  
PRINT HOLD will send the items to the printer.  
WARN IF HELD ITEMS AT FINALIZE  
This indicates to the employee when a bill is being cashed off, that there were items still on hold that had not  
being printed.  
TRACK 2 HOLDS CLOSED CHKS FROM TRACK 1  
If this flag is activated, TRACK 2 is not to be used as a normal open check balance storage system. It is an  
archive for closed checks which were opened on tracking method 1. As a check is closed on tracking method 1,  
the data is stored in check files 2, available for reporting by printing OPEN CHECK TRACK#2. The maximum  
file size for data storage is determined by the MAXIMUM NUMBER of checks set in the memory allocation.  
TRACK 4 HOLDS CLOSED CHKS FROM TRACK 3  
If this flag is activated, TRACK 4 is not to be used as a normal open check balance storage system. It is an  
archive for closed checks, which were opened on tracking method 3. As a check is closed on tracking method 1,  
the data is stored in check files 3, available for reporting by printing OPEN CHECK TRACK#4 The maximum  
file size for data storage is determined by the MAXIMUM NUMBER of checks set in the memory allocation.  
STARTING CHECK# 1 – 4  
When using the auto check number generation system this is the number from which the checks will begin to be  
generated, each file can have a different starting number.  
135  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
TRACKING FILE OPTIONS  
CHECK# LIMIT 1 - 4  
This is the maximum number that can be automaticallty generated by the terminal, and works in-conjunction with  
the starting check number, when the limit is reached the message, buffer full will appear until one of the existing  
checks is finalised.  
RESET CHECK # 1- 4 AT (Z1 FINANCIAL, Z1 OPEN CHECK, NEVER)  
When running a system with automatic check number generation, the check numbers can be reset back to the  
stating check number at one of three stages.  
SHOW BACKUP MASTER DOWN INDICATOR  
If the system is programmed to allow the live check tracking data to be stored in another terminal this will  
provided an indicator on the register display, showing the situation of the backup terminal, checking the status  
every time the IRC network is interigated.  
136  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
KITCHEN PRINTING/VIDEO OPTIONS  
PRINT AT KP:  
TOTAL AMOUNT LINE  
The sale total can be printed on the kitchen printer showing the total value for the items printed.  
PRINT SEAT#  
This provides extra information for waitresses by printing the seat number of the food ordered.  
ORDER#  
This is especially useful when a check number is not used as the order number identifies what sale/customer the  
food produced is to be served to. This can also be used as a global order number providing a central consecutive  
number for all food orders printed in the kitchen.  
TRANSACTION VOID ITEMS  
This will print items/sales removed from a sale to the kitchen printer indicating those items are no longer  
required.  
PLU CODE  
This will print the PLU number alongside the description on the printer.  
PLU PRICE  
This will print the price of the product alongside the description on the kitchen printer, when used with the total  
amount line print, this provides a good substitute for a sales receipt.  
ENABLE SORT KP BY KP GROUP #  
The information is printed on the kitchen printer in the order the food was sold; however this may not necessarily  
be a logical order for the chef. It is possible using this system flag to identify the preparation group it refers to i.e.  
starter, main courses etc. A sale that is then entered in a random order will be re-sorted by the preparation group.  
# LINE FEED AT BEGIN OF KP PRINT  
It is possible to feed the paper before information is printed; this in-turn makes the receipt issued longer. This  
system flags relates to items printed on the Kitchen Printer and not to the receipt.  
# LINE FEED AT END OF KP PRINT  
It is possible to feed the paper after information is printed; this in-turn makes the receipt issued, longer. This  
system flags relates to items printed on the Kitchen Printer and not to the receipt  
SEND ORDERS TO KP ON SUBTOTAL  
This flag show items on the Kitchen Printer when the SUBTOTAL key is pressed.  
COMBINE LIKE ITEMS ON KP OR KVS  
The same product can be printed separately when more than one has been sold or print consolidation on one line  
with a quantity and total value. This also applies to the kitchen video as well as the printer.  
137  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
KITCHEN PRINTING/VIDEO OPTIONS  
SEND ORDERS TO KVS ON SUBTOTAL  
This flag show items on the Kitchen Video System when the SUBTOTAL key is pressed.  
PRINT VOIDED ORDERS AT KP OR KVS  
When food is no longer required. This options means items, voided on the terminal, are printed.  
KP IS Y=REAL TIME / N=BATCH  
This flag controls when the items are printed to the kitchen printer. If the real time option is selected each item  
will be printed the moment it is sold; this results in one receipt per product. The alternative is to select batch  
printing, which prints items when the sale is complete producing a ticket for all items  
KVS IS Y=REAL TIME / N=BATCH  
This flag controls when items are to be displayed on the Kitchen Video System. When Real time is selected the  
items are displayed. The alternative is batch, items are then shown at the end of sale  
USE KP ROUTER (THE SAME FOR ALL REG, SEPARATELY)  
The terminal has the capabiltiy of four pages of kitchen printer output settings, each controlled by time, manually  
using the KP routing key or the analysis keys. The four pages can apply to the whole network, or each terminal  
can have four completely indepant pages.  
KP ORDER# COMBINATION OF REG#&CONS# or GLOBAL  
The order number can be either the register and consecutive number combination or used as a global order  
number providing a central consecutive number for all food orders printed in the kitchen.  
DISPLAY KP TIME PERIOD#  
This indicates on the register display, which one of the four printer pages is currently being printed to.  
DISPLAY KP ORDER#  
The order number being currently printed in the kitchen can be displayed on the register display.  
SEPARATE KP BY KP GROUP#  
Each product is linked to a kitchen print group, these groups are then allocated to the appropriate printer separate  
printers, can print any group once or upto nine times. This will print a receipt for each group.  
SEPARATE BY KP ITEM  
A separate kitchen ticket can be issued per product, producing one order receipt per item.  
138  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
VALIDATION/SUBTOTAL OPTIONS  
VALIDATION AMT: Y=TOTAL / N=TENDER  
When a sale requires validation the information printed can be one of two things either the total value of the sale  
or the value of money received/tendered.  
CHK VALID AMT: Y=TOTAL / N=TENDER  
When a cheque requires validation the information printed can be one of two things either the total value of the  
sale or the value of money received/tendered.  
ACTIVATE VALIDATION SENSOR  
Validation can take place with or without a sensor being activated, the sensor is only required to be activated if  
operators require guidance as to whether the paper is inserted correctly. The availability of a sensor will also be  
dependent on the type of printer being used.  
ALLOW MULTIPLE VALIDATIONS  
It is normal that an operator validates a sale only once for example cheques, however if this were used for tickets  
it may be necessary to validate the information onto multiple sheets.  
PRINT VALIDATION MESSAGE  
In addition to the sale being printed, there can also be a pre-programmed message printed.  
PRINT SUBTOTAL WHEN SUBTOTAL KEY IS PRESSED.  
Subtotal is normally printed at finalisation this however allows a subtotal to be printed whenever the key is  
pressed, providing mid sale totals as well as the final subtotal.  
VALIDATION PORT# (0 –7)  
This is the physical port number through which the validation printer is connected  
139  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
GENERAL PRINTING OPTIONS  
PRINT ON RECEIPT:  
This controls what will be printed on the receipt ticket.  
EMPLOYEE NAME  
This programs whether the employee name will be printed on the receipt  
CONSECUTIVE #  
This programs whether the consecutive transaction number will be printed on the receipt  
Items by Group  
The products can be printed on the receipt in the order they were entered or in the sorted into their group, i.e. all  
food together, then all drinks, they are sorted using the PLU programmed Group#1  
DATE  
This programs whether the date will be printed on the receipt  
TIME  
This programs whether the time will be printed on the receipt  
PREAMBLE/POSTAMBLE  
It is possible to print a message at the top of the receipt; this is referred to as the PRE-AMBLE message. It is also  
possible to print a message at the bottom of the receipt this is referred to as the POST-AMBLE message. This  
programs whether the messages will be printed.  
ORDER #  
This programs whether the ORDER # will be printed on the receipt  
SEAT #  
This programs whether the SEAT # will be printed on the receipt  
RECEIPT FEED LINES AFTER PRINT  
The receipt can be increased in length by enter the number of extra lines to feed after printing. This applies only  
to receipt print, not kitchen printing. If an overall number of lines feed are required for the printer whatever the  
print, it is programmed in s-mode port definition.  
LINES AFTER PREAMBLE  
It is possible to print a message at the top of the receipt; this is referred to as the PRE-AMBLE message. This  
programs how many extra lines are fed after the message before sales details  
LINES BEFORE POSTAMBLE  
It is possible to print a message at the bottom of the receipt this is referred to as the POST-AMBLE message.  
This programs how many extra lines a fed before printing the bottom logo message.  
BUFFERED RECEIPT: Y=STUB / N=FULL  
When the receipt is printed after the sale is completed i.e. buffered the information printed can be an abbreviated  
financial stub or a full-itemised receipt.  
140  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
GENERAL PRINTING OPTIONS  
PRINT RECEIPT WHEN SIGNING ON/OFF  
It is possible to issue a receipt for each employee that signs into the system for registration  
PRINT RECEIPT WHEN CLOCKING IN/OUT  
It is possible to issue a receipt for each employee that clocks into the system for time clocking  
CONDENSE TRAY SUBTOTAL RECEIPTS  
The system has a function called tray subtotals. This allows users to press a key; to issue a receipt for the items  
sold since the last press of the tray subtotal key. The sale is continued tray subtotal is again within the sales to  
issue receipts for further items. It is then possible to finalise and receive a completed receipt. This feature is ideal  
when a ticket is required for items within a sale, as well as a payment receipt for the whole transaction. This  
option allows the printed information to be condensed, reducing the amount of paper used  
JOURNAL Y=REAL TIME / N=BATCH  
The timing of the print to the journal can be controlled; real time means the moment a product is sold the  
information is printed. The alternative is batch printing; the information is printed at the end of sale.  
PRINT PLU CODE WITH DESCRIPTOR  
It is assumed not necessary as standard to print the product code of the item sold, as most clients do not refer to  
the code number. However in a scanning system or a retail environment this information may be required in  
addition to the product description. This flag print the product code number every time the description is printed.  
I.e. when the product is used.  
TRANSACTION # IS RANDOM NUMBER  
The receipt identifying number can be changed from sequential to random if required.  
HOME CURRENCY SYMBOL  
The monetary symbol for the country in which the machine is based. I.e. £s , Pts, etc.  
CONVERTED CURRENCY 1 SYMBOL  
The symbol printed when money is entered using currency conversion key 1. Conversion one is the rate used for  
EURO conversion.  
CONVERTED CURRENCY 2 - 5 SYMBOL  
The symbol printed when money is entered using currency conversion key 2 - 5  
141  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
GENERAL PRINTING OPTIONS  
PRINT TENDER ON RECEIPT  
This controls whether the amount given by the customer for payment is printed on the receipt or whether the sales  
total only is displayed.  
DISABLE LINE FEED ON SLIP PRINTER  
The slip printer is especially design to take loose-leaf paper, and automatically print in the appropriate position  
for a check on the paper. The position can be manually modified using a LINE FEED key. This option prohibits  
manual override.  
GUEST CHECK PREAMBLE/POSTAMBLE  
There are two types of logo messages, the standard sales receipt message, or the alternative guest bill check  
tracking message. This option decides which is to be used. I.e. the same sales receipt logo message on all prints  
outs, or a specific guest check message to be printed on bill. This may include messages like TIPS ARE AT  
YOUR DISCRETION, PLEASE SIGN HERE etc… not normally required on a standard sales receipt.  
PRINT RECEIPT AUTOMATICALLY  
When the receipt is switched on, a sales receipt will be issued either every time a sale is made i.e. automatically.  
or when the Receipt Issue key is pressed. If the receipt switch is turned off neither of the options apply. This flag  
when set to Y will issue a receipt every time a sale is made, whilst the receipt is on. The alternative being  
pressing the receipt issuance key.  
PRINT RECEIPT AFTER TIME CLOCK EDIT  
This is an option receipt print when the time clock wages data is editted manually in the X-MODE.  
PRINT GROUP NAME WHEN PRINTING ITEMS BY GROUP  
When the receipt is sorted by group it is possible to have the group name printed at the top of each group section.  
PRINT GUEST CHECK PRINT COUNT ON GC  
This will print at the bottom of each bill produced the number of times the bill has been issued.  
PRINT AS FOREIGN CURRENCY 1  
Foreign Currency 1 is normally the Euro’s, this feature helps deal with the necessity of dual pricing in Euro’s.  
Each of the following determines when the home currency rate is to be printed alongside with the EURO total.  
TOTAL  
This prints the total of the sale in Euro’s as well as home currency  
TENDER  
CHANGE  
This prints the value of monies given in payment in Euro’s as well as home currency.  
This prints the total of change given in Euro’s as well as home currency.  
142  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
GENERAL PRINTING OPTIONS  
DISABLE PRINTING IN CURRENCY CONV.  
When converting a total from home currency to a foreign currency, there is standard information printed, the  
following can be suppressed.  
CHANGE RATE  
FOREIGN AMOUNT This is the value entered for payment in the foreign currency.  
HOME AMOUNT This is the value entered for payment in foreign currency converted to the equivalent  
in home currency.  
This is the current rate of exchange used for the conversion  
PRINT ALL CURRENCY IN CONV2-5 OPERATION  
This allows when using EUROs dual pricing and payment in a furthe currency to print both the information in  
EUROs also in the currency by which the sale is to be paid.  
TOTAL  
This prints the total of the sale in Euro’s as well as home currency  
TENDER  
CHANGE  
This prints the value of monies given in payment in Euro’s as well as home currency.  
This prints the total of change given in Euro’s as well as home currency.  
143  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
REPORT PRINTING OPTIONS  
ZERO SKIP (ALL OPTIONS)  
This prevents unused items for printing on the report, it is advisable these features are turned on, as the reports  
will increase dramatically in length if no zero skip is performed.  
PRINT % OF SALES ON PLU REPORT  
The product report prints as standard the quantity and value sold per product this can than be used to calculate  
the percent value of total sales that item has achieved.  
PRINT LINKED GROUPS ON PLU REPORT  
The products can be linked to groups for sales analysis by category; it is possible to print this number on the  
report to help identify the product category.  
PROMO/WASTE TOTALS ON PLU REPORT  
It is possible to print along side the products sales information the quantity of items that have been issued as  
wastage, also the number of items that have been sold as promotional products.  
INDIVIDUAL ITEM USAGE QTY ON PLU REPORT  
This will print not only the total quantity sold, but also the total usage which is calculated from an addition of  
quantity sold + Promotion Products + Wastage items.  
COUNT ON TIME REPORT IS CUSTOMER / GUEST  
The hourly report indicates the value of sales made during that time. The counter can be either the total number  
of transactions per hour referred to as the customer count. The alternative is using the GUEST# key totalling the  
number of entries, i.e. how many people have visited the establishment.  
USE FUNCTION KEY DESCRIPTOR IN RPT  
This allows a different description to be used during registration to that printed on the reports. When the default  
desctiption of the function key is change from the default settings this alternative description will print during  
registeration, the choice is then wether the description is to be used for reporting or wether the default settings are  
to be used.  
PRINT MINIMUM STOCK RPT AFTER FINANCIAL RPT  
This will print for those products program as stock items with a minimum stock figure, the status of the stock for  
those below minimum this will appear at the bottom of the financail report, resetting the minimum stock report  
when the financial report is issued as a Z, ie. Assuming that the stock items have been re-odered and are no  
longer required on the minimum stock report.  
144  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
REPORT OPTIONS  
ONLY TTL ON PRODUCT MIX GROUP RPT  
The product mix groups are used to identify item usage and sales of selected products by time range. This flag  
changes the format of the report for a time period analysis per product group to a total analysis per group,  
reducing the length of the report.  
ONLY ITEMS WITH ACTUAL INV ENTRY  
This will when set only print out ingredients which have had the actual stock figures entered for them, ie only  
those items which have had stock counted and entered.  
CASH DECLARATION COMPULSORY  
This system flag forces the operator to enter the value of moneys in the drawer before reporting  
SIGN ON EMPLOYEE BEFORE REPORTS  
It is not compulsory for an employee to be signed into the system before producing a report. However if extra  
security is required, this flag can be activated forcing employee sign on before reporting  
ENFORCE ACTUAL INVENTORY BEFORE Z1  
This forces the current stock situation for each ingredient to be entered before reporting  
RETAIN ACTUAL INV ENTRIES IN X1  
This prevents the ingredient stock figures entered in X mode prior to the report being from being cleared, I.e.  
once the currenct stock situation has been enterd and a variance report produced should this information be  
retained or cleared.  
RESET PLU REPORT AT INVENTORY Z1  
This will reset the PLU sales quantity and value report when reset ingredient inventory information. This should  
be considered carefully as an option, ensuring that your intentions are to reset PLU sales  
RESET INVENTORY REPORT AT PLU Z1  
This will reset the ingredient inventory data when the PLU sales quantity and values are reset. This should be  
considered careful as an option, ensuring that your intentions to rest the information is what you require.  
TIME KEEPING Y=MINUTES / N=100 UNITS  
The clocking In/Out option can calculate labour costing based on minutes or 100s of an hour, Minutes are option  
most commonly required In the UK.  
OMIT TAX TOTALS FROM NET SALES GT  
The system a running financial totals this, as standard will include any tax charged. This can be omitted  
145  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
REPORT OPTIONS  
ALLOW Z OF OPEN CHECKS REPORTS  
The system assumes that all checks opened will be paid it is possible to allow or disallow clearing of these.  
CONFIRM BEFORE TOTALS RESET ON Z  
If this flag is set the system will request a key press once a Z report is run to active clearing of the totals. It is a  
security measure to ensure the operator is aware of their actions.  
RESET AFTER FINANCIAL Z REPORT  
GROSS SALES GT  
This is the running total of the retail value of goods sold. It is not normally reset when a financial report is issued,  
as its purpose is to provide an on going GRAND TOTAL  
NET SALES GT  
This is the running total of the monetary value of goods sold. It is not normally reset when a financial report is  
issued, as its purpose is to provide an on going GRAND TOTAL  
NEGATIVE SALES GT  
This is the running total of all negative products sold. It is not normally reset when a financial report is issued, as  
its purpose is to provide an on going GRAND TOTAL  
Z COUNTER  
This counter is used to show the total and number of each type of report that have been taken. Resetting  
startingthe numbering each time a Z report is taken.  
CONSECUTIVE #  
This counter is used to number each receipt that has ever been issued. Resetting start the numbering each time a Z  
report is taken.  
VOID MODE TOTALS ADD TO GRAND TOTALS  
The running grand totals are totals of sales and finical information for goods and moneys received; Voids are  
normally deducted from these totals It is possible to reverse this and add voids taken to the totals. It is not the  
norm to set this flag; there are certain environments where it is applicable.  
ALLOW Z WITH OPEN ORDERS  
It is possilble to decide wether the system will allow resetting of the terminal when there are open balances.  
146  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
TIME KEEPING OPTIONS  
OVERTIME HOUR IS USED FOR DAY OR WEEK  
Overtime can be paid on the number of hours worked per day or week. I.e. 8 hours a day or 37 hours per week.  
HOURS PER OVERTIME STARTS  
Once an employee’s total hours worked have reached this point then an overtime rate will be paid.  
OVERTIME FACTOR  
This is the ratio of the pay rate for overtime for example 1.5 will indicate time and a half.  
ENFORCE (OUT FOR BREAK) OR (EXIT) ENTRY  
This enforces the employee to enter why they are clocking out either for a break or to clock off  
TIP REPORTING % OF SALES  
The tips earned can be calculated as a ratio of sales that each employee has achieved. This is the percentage value  
employees will earn  
EMPLOYEE TIME IN/OUT – SECRET CODE  
There are various employee restrictions to clocking on to the system. The standard register sign on code can be  
used as the clock in code, or an alternative separate clock in code can be allocated. This option determines which  
code is to be used for time in/out operation.  
147  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYSTEM OPTION – DEFINITIONS  
E.J. & DETAIL PRINTING OPTIONS  
ACTIVATE ELECTRONIC JOURNAL  
This enables the electronic journal, storing all actions made on the terminal can be stored to the memory for  
reporting.  
DISPLAY E.J. BUFFER FULL WARNING  
The terminal has a maximum number of lines which is allocated in the initial memory allocation. When this is  
reached the terminal can display a warning indicating it is time to take a reset report  
E.J. OVERRIDE WHEN BUFFER FULL  
When the maximum limit is reached a reset can be forced to clear the totals. The alternative is to start at the  
oldest information stored and begin to overwrite the information, providing a continuous loop. It should be noted,  
the oldest data is overwritten and cannot be reported on.  
SEND TO ELECTRONIC JOURNAL  
This terminal has a very sophisticated analysis on journal reporting. All information can be sent to the terminal  
and when reported extracted as required i.e. all Cash Transactions, VOIDs etc. The alternative here is to send  
only to the journal the information that you require. This will save on the memory required, as only part  
information is stored. The system then ceases to operate as a true journal of all transactions but provides a  
monitoring system for the information that you require tracking. The choices available are.  
CASH TRANSACTIONS  
- All cash sales made during normal operation  
CHEQUE TRANSACTIONS  
- All check sales made during normal operation  
MISC TENDER TRANSACTIONS - All Miscellaneous sales made during normal operation  
TRANSACTIONS WITH %  
RECD ACCT & PAID OUT  
RETURN TRANSACTIONS  
TRANSACTIONS WITH  
ERR CORRECT & VOID  
NO SALES  
CANCEL TRANSACTIONS  
TRANSACTIONS WITH  
NEGATIVE ITEMS  
- All sales containing a discount or premium operation  
- All received on account or Paid out sales transactions  
- All Merchandise Return sales transactions  
- All Transactions containing an error correct or void.  
- All Transactions containing no sale operations.  
- All Register Mode cancelled transactions  
- All Transactions with negative product sales.  
REPORTS  
PROGRAM SCANS  
- All Read & Reset reports which are printed  
- All Program scans, which are printed.  
CHECK TRACKING  
- All movement on open checks can be stored  
SEND TO DETAIL  
When an electronic journal is not used, it is possible to use a detailed audit printer the following information can  
be prevented from printing.  
TRANSACTIONS WITH  
NEGATIVE ITEMS  
REPORTS  
- All transactions with negative products  
- All Read and Reset reports which are printed  
PROGRAM SCANS  
- All Program scans which are printed.  
148  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                      
                                                                      
TAX  
Tax can be programmed as; addition where the value of tax is added to each products retail price or extraction  
where the system calculates the amount of VAT included within a sale  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. PLU  
2. PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. GROUP  
4. FUNCTION KEY  
5. SYSTEM OPTION  
6. TAXES  
7. MESSAGES  
8. WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
9. TIME PERIOD  
10. EMPLOYEE  
11. AUTHORITY LEVEL  
12. PRINTER TABLES & KV ROUTING  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
TAX PROGRAMMING  
L1  
TAX#1 BY VAT  
RATE  
L1  
1. TAX 1  
2. TAX 2  
3. TAX 3  
4. TAX 4  
5. TAX 5  
6. TAX 6  
VADD ON  
TAX
17.500  
TABLE  
A
ADD ON  
ADD ON  
ADD ON  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓  
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓  
149  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                             
                             
MESSAGES  
Various text can be reprogrammed changing the default settings. It is also possible to  
program receipt and bill header/footer messages in this section  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
MESSAGES MENU  
L1  
1. LOGO MESSAGE  
2. ERROR MESSAGE  
1. PLU  
2. PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. GROUP  
4. FUNCTION KEY  
5. SYSTEM OPTION  
6. TAXES  
3. SYSTEM DESCRIPTORS  
4. REPORT DESCRIPTORS  
5. CHEQUE ENDORSEMENT MESSAGE  
6. GUEST CHECK LOGO MESSAGE  
7. VALIDATION MESSAGE  
7. MESSAGES  
8. WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
9. TIME PERIOD  
10. EMPLOYEE  
11. AUTHORITY LEVEL  
12. PRINTER TABLES & KV ROUTING  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓  
LOGO MESSAGES  
Used to program the sales receipt Post-amble header message and Pre-amble footer message, The justification  
selection can be used to auto centre etc the programmed messaged.  
ERROR MESSAGES  
This can be used to change the default error message to your own custom requirements.  
SYSTEM DESCRIPTORS  
This contains the terminals default descriptions such as SUBTOTAL, TAXES etc. This option can used to  
change the default settings to your own custom messages.  
REPORT DESCRIPTORS  
This can be used to change the default report descriptions such as GROSS, NET etc to your own requirements.  
CHEQUE ENDORSEMENT MESSAGE  
This can be used to program the message that will be printed on a check when the endorsement key is used.  
GUEST CHECK LOGO MESSAGE  
Used to program the guest bill tracking receipt Post Header message and Pre-amble footer message, The  
justification selection can be used to auto centre etc the programmed messaged. The option to use guest message  
or receipt message when printing a bill is programmable in the system options  
VALIDATION MESSGE  
Used to print a message when the validation feature is in use.  
150  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFAULT ERROR MESSAGES  
NO.  
1
DESCRIPTION  
(NOT USE)  
NO.  
111  
DESCRIPTION  
NEGATIVE CARD  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
(NOT USE)  
AMOUNT REQUIRED  
BAD VALUE  
BUFFER FULL  
BUFFER EMPTY  
BUSY  
BAD COMMAND  
CASH DECALATION REQUIRED  
CASH-IN-DRAWER EXCEEDED  
CHECK# ASSIGNED AUTO  
CHECK# REQUIRED !  
CONDIMENT REQUIRED!  
CRC ERROR  
112  
113  
114  
115  
116  
117  
118  
119  
120  
121  
122  
123  
124  
125  
126  
127  
128  
129  
130  
131  
132  
133  
134  
135  
136  
137  
138  
139  
140  
141  
142  
143  
144  
145  
146  
147  
148  
149  
150  
151  
152  
153  
154  
155  
156  
157  
158  
159  
160  
161  
162  
163  
LINKED STATUS REQUIRED  
RETURN TO X-MODE  
ERROR - SLIP PAPER  
LOCAL PRINTER REQUIRED  
MODE ERROR  
SET TIME&DATE IS DECATIVATED  
EMPLOYEE SHOULD BE DIFFERENT  
TRANSFER NOT ALLOWED  
REQ GALLONAGE AMOUNT  
AVAILABLE ONLY IN CHECK  
SPLIT THIS ITEM NOT POSSIBLE  
FUNCTION KEY NOT INCLUDED  
ERROR POST TENDER  
NO TRACKING DATA IN THIS REG  
NO TIME KEEP DATA IN THIS REG  
MULTIPLICATION LIMIT EXCEEDED  
TAB OF FIELD2 TOO BIG  
NON-PLU CODE RANGE OVER  
TARE ENTRY NOT ALLOWED  
MISC TEND REQUIRED  
SAME CHECK TRACK REQUIRED  
NOT SCALEABLE PLU  
EJ BUFFER FULL  
MUST BE START<=END IN RANGE  
RANGE OVERLAP  
FINAL END SHOULD BE 9 OR 99  
NOT PLU  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
51  
52  
53  
DUPLICATE!  
ANALYSIS1/2/3  
ENTER EMPLOYEE CODE  
ENTER EMPLOYEE #  
ENTER GUEST COUNT  
ENTER SEAT#  
ENTER TABLE#  
ENTRY REQUIRED  
ERROR  
ERROR JAM  
TABLE NUMBER IN USE  
HALO OVER!  
ILLEGAL KEY SEQUENCE  
IN USE!  
INACTIVE!  
NOT WLU  
PRINT KEY REQUIRED  
INPUT QTY  
KITCHEN PRINTER FAILURE  
MANAGER REQUIRED  
MANAGER OVERRIDE REQUIRE  
MEMORY FULL  
NEGATIVE  
NO CHECK#  
NO DATA  
NO DRAWER!  
NO MANUAL ENTRY  
NO PAPER  
NO PLU!  
NON ADD# REQUIRED  
NOT DISCOUNTABLE  
NOT PROGRAMMED!  
NOT READY!  
NOT ZERO  
OFF LINE!  
OPEN DRAWER  
P/BAL REQUIRED  
PAPER END  
RANGE OVER  
REMOVE PAPER  
SCALE FAIL!  
SURCHARGE NOT ALLOWED  
DECIMAL ENTRY REQUIRED  
SYSTEM REG# REQUIRED  
TRAINING EMP FILE# REQUIRED  
TIME IN/OUT REG# REQUIRED  
CHECK TRACKING REG# REQUIRED  
ELECTRONIC JOURNAL INACTIVE  
CHEQUE ENDORSEMENT REQUIRED  
EFT TERMIANL TRANS. KEY ERROR  
CARD ERROR  
PRINTER OFFLINE  
KV OFFLINE  
NO RELOCATABLE KEY  
CLERK KEY ERROR  
ENFORCE ACTUAL INVENTORY  
AUTHORITY LEVEL NOT LINKED  
WEIGHT IS ZERO  
STOCK IS NOT ZERO  
CLEAR CAN NOT BE REMOVED  
ENTER CAN NOT BE REMOVED  
YES/NO CAN NOT BE REMOVED  
THIS NUMERIC CAN’T BE REMOVED  
INCORRECT CODE  
151  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFAULT ERROR MESSAGES  
54  
55  
56  
57  
58  
59  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
65  
66  
67  
68  
SCALE REQUIRED!  
SINGLE ITEM!  
SUBTOTAL REQUIRED  
SYSTEM ERROR  
TARE# REQUIRED  
TRAY SUBTOTAL REQUIRED!  
VALIDATION REQUIRED  
WASTE REQUIRED!  
WRONG EMPLOYEE  
SIGN OFF REQUIRED  
164  
165  
166  
167  
168  
169  
170  
171  
172  
173  
174  
175  
176  
177  
178  
SOFT CHECK ONLY  
INACTIVE PLU  
MULTIPLE DISCOUNT NOT ALLOWED  
NEW CHECK OPENED  
NO MORE SPLIT TENDER ALLOWED  
CHECK POLE DISPLAY  
MUST MAX.NONTAXABLE<=BRK PNT1  
MUST BRK PNT n <= BRK PNT n+1  
NOT ALLOWED WITH OPEN ORDERS  
NOW POLLING !!  
INCORRECT TARE WEIGHT  
MIX AND MATCH ERROR  
CLERK INTERRUPT ERROR  
CHECK OPENED NO DATA  
NO CLERK BUFFER IN THIS REG  
ZERO AMOUNT  
PRICE LEVEL MISMATCH  
OVERRIDE NOT ALLOWED  
WRONG SEQUENCE  
WRONG COMMAND  
69  
WRONG FILE NO  
70  
71  
72  
73  
WRONG ITEMMIZER  
UNDER TEND NOT ALLOWED  
OVER TEND NOT ALLOWED  
CHECK TRACKING ERROR  
USING  
74  
75  
PLU NOT ALLOWED  
76  
77  
78  
79  
CONDIMENT PLU NOT ALLOWED  
NON-CONDIMENT PLU NOT ALLOWED  
FUNCTION KEY NOT ALLOWED  
THIS KEY NOT ALLOWED  
NO FUNCTION KEY  
80  
81  
82  
NO PROGRAMMABLE KEY  
X/TIME REQUIRED  
83  
84  
INVALID AUTHORITY LEVEL  
TIME IN REQUIRED  
85  
SIGN ON REQUIRED  
86  
87  
88  
MEMORY NOT ALLOCATED  
THIS EMP. RPT MUST BE CLEARED  
ERROR STATUS  
89  
ERROR VALUE  
90  
91  
ERROR SYSTEM OPTION  
ERORR EMPLOYEE  
92  
ERROR TABLE NO  
93  
SCALE MOTION  
94  
OVER WEIGHT  
95  
UNDER WEIGHT  
96  
97  
98  
PROMO NOT ALLOWED  
WASTE NOT ALLOWED  
NO FOOD STAMP AMOUNT  
DECIMAL ENTRY NOT ALLOWED  
SPLIT PRICING NOT ALLOWED  
VOID MODE IS DEACTIVATED  
JOB CODE REQUIRED  
JOB CODE CHANGE NOT ALLOWED  
PUSH BUTTON ENTRY REQUIRED  
EMPLOYEE CODE NOT LINKED  
TENDERING IS NOT ALLOWED  
OVER REGULAR HOURS PER WEEK  
MUST <= LINE# PER TRANSACTION  
MUST >= LINE# PER SOFT CHECK  
NO STOCK PLU  
99  
100  
101  
102  
103  
104  
105  
106  
107  
108  
109  
110  
152  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFAULT SYSTEM DESCRIPTORS  
NO.  
1
DESCRIPTION  
SUN  
NO.  
55  
DESCRIPTION  
PAYMENT  
2
3
MON  
TUE  
56  
57  
HOME AMT  
FSCRT  
4
WED  
58  
FS EXMT  
5
6
7
8
THU  
FRI  
SAT  
MGR  
TAXES  
TOTAL  
FSTAX  
FSTTL  
FSCNG  
DATE  
TIME  
NO.  
CASH  
CHEQ  
MISC  
REG  
PLU#  
PBAL  
SEAT#  
ESC  
TBL  
GST  
EMPL.  
FOR  
59  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
65  
66  
67  
68  
69  
70  
71  
72  
73  
74  
75  
76  
77  
78  
79  
80  
81  
82  
83  
84  
85  
86  
87  
88  
89  
90  
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
97  
98  
99  
100  
101  
102  
103  
104  
105  
106  
107  
108  
109  
SCALE CANCEL  
TIP PAID OUT  
TIP DECLARED  
TAXABLE 1  
TAXABLE 2  
TAXABLE 3  
TAXABLE 4  
TAXABLE 5  
TAXABLE 6  
TAX1 AMT  
TAX2 AMT  
TAX3 AMT  
TAX4 AMT  
TAX5 AMT  
TAX6 AMT  
VAT1 AMT  
VAT2 AMT  
VAT3 AMT  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
51  
52  
53  
54  
VAT4 AMT  
VAT5 AMT  
VAT6 AMT  
EXEMPT TAX1  
EXEMPT TAX2  
EXEMPT TAX3  
EXEMPT TAX4  
EXEMPT TAX5  
EXEMPT TAX6  
TAX TOTAL  
NO SEAT  
POST TENDER  
SYSTEM  
BALANCE  
CHECK#  
CLOCK OUT  
CLOSED  
PRICE/HALO  
DESCRIPTOR  
LINK GROUP  
LINK STATUS  
CHANGE RATE  
FOREIGN AMT  
REG MODE  
VD MODE  
MGR MODE  
CONV  
GAS CNT  
GAS AMT  
ORDER#  
AMOUNT REQUIRED  
*****TRAINING*****  
TIME CLOCK – IN  
TIME CLOCK – OUT  
EMPLOYEE SIGN ON  
EMPLOYEE SIGN OFF  
DECLARE CASH TIPS  
↑↓←→ ENT  
↑↓←→ ENT DONE  
↑↓←→ ENT X/TM  
↑↓←→ ENT DONE X/TM  
ADD CHECKS FOR PAYMENT  
** NOT CLOSED CHECKS **  
ENTER NEW SEAT#  
EMPLOYEE  
AMT DUE  
CHANGE  
JOB CODE  
SUMMARY  
OUT FOR BRK  
OUT  
OPERATOR  
NON-ADD#  
INPUT QTY  
ENTER TIME:  
TRANS VD  
REPRINT  
GROUP0  
DELETED PLU  
153  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
154  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                 
                                                                 
WLU – WINDOW LOOK UP  
There are three types of items that can be found on a Window Look-Up (WLU): condiments,  
functions, and PLUs. The same WLU can contain any combination of condiments,  
functions, and PLUs.  
Specific features and rules for WLUs are summarised below:  
A specific WLU can be activated automatically after a PLU is entered.  
A specific WLU ,can be activated by pressing a WLU key on the keyboard. Or, by  
placing the WLU# key on the keyboard, any number of WLUs can be accessed by typing  
the WLU number and pressing the WLU# key.  
A WLU can be linked to a subsequent WLU in order to prompt an operator through a  
sequence of selections.  
The order in which items appear on a WLU can be controlled by adding them in a  
specific order. Items can be deleted, or items can be added in the middle of a list.  
The total number of WLUs and the capacity of each WLU is set in memory allocation.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. PLU  
2. PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. GROUP  
4. FUNCTION KEY  
5. SYSTEM OPTION  
6. TAXES  
7. MESSAGES  
8. WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
9. TIME PERIOD  
10. EMPLOYEE  
11. AUTHORITY LEVEL  
12. PRINTER TABLES & KV ROUTING  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
WLU# 1 PROGRAMMING  
L1  
WLU# 1 PROGRAMMING  
L1  
PLU/COND NO  
STARTERS  
1 SOUP  
2 MELON  
3 SALMON  
4 PATE  
5 SORBET  
6 SALAD  
7 JUICE  
8 PRAWN COCKTL  
9 SPECIAL 1  
10 SPECIAL 2  
↑↓←→
ENT DONE  
1. TITLE :  
2. ALLOW CONDIMENT  
ALLOW PLU  
ALLOW FUNCTIONS  
3. # OF ITEM CHOICES (0=UNLIMTED)  
4. ITEM MULTIPLICATION?  
5. ALLOW EXIT FROM TABLE WITH DONE? Y  
6. LINK TO WLU# (0=NO LINK)  
STARTERS  
N
THEN PLU KEY  
OR PRESS KEY  
OR FROM LIST  
PLU=LIST PLUS  
ESC=LIST FUNC  
PLU=LIST COND  
Y
Y
00  
N
00  
ERR.CORR. KEY  
TO DELETE  
EDIT ITEMS  
DONE TO EXIT  
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
155  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WLU – WINDOW LOOK UP DEFINITIONS  
WLU#  
This is the sequential window number, used to program the WLU key to the keyboard, or to allocate to a PLU for  
pop up windows, or for reigistration by code using the WLU key.  
TITLE  
This is the name of the window for display purposes only  
ALLOW CONDIMENT  
This decides whether the window is to include condiment PLUs (cooking instructions)  
ALLOW PLU  
This decides whether the window is to include PLUs  
ALLOW FUNCTIONS  
This decides whether the window is to include function keys  
# OF ITEM CHOICES  
If you select 1 in this field, when a condiment is selected from the WLU, the WLU is automatically closed. In  
the same manner, if you select 2, the WLU is automatically closed after the second WLU is registered. If you  
select 0, any number of selections can be made, The WLU is then closed by pressing DONE.  
ALLOW EXIT FROM TABLE WITH DONE  
This allows the user to leave the window without fulfilling all the compulsory requirements such as number of  
choices.  
LINK TO WLU#  
It is possible to link windows together, so that when the requirements of one window has been completed the next  
window is displayed.  
156  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                           
                                                                           
TIME PERIOD  
Memory allocation determines whether there are 24, 48, or 96 time periods. Time periods  
will default to hourly periods if 24 periods are selected in memory allocation; 30 minute  
periods if 48 periods are selected; 15 minute periods if 96 periods are selected. Periods can  
be set to custom lengths using this program. If fewer periods are needed than are available,  
unneeded periods can be made inactive so that they will not appear on reports. To make  
inactive a period, replace the "Y" (active) for the period with an "N" (inactive). All time units  
are based upon a 24 hour clock  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. PLU  
2. PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. GROUP  
4. FUNCTION KEY  
5. SYSTEM OPTION  
6. TAXES  
7. MESSAGES  
8. WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
9. TIME PERIOD  
10. EMPLOYEE  
11. AUTHORITY LEVEL  
12. PRINTER TABLES & KV ROUTING  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
TIME PERIOD PROGRAMMING  
L1  
# OF PERIODS SET IN MEMORY : 24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
(Y) 00:00 – 00:59 13 (Y) 12:00 – 12:59  
(Y) 01:00 – 01:59 14 (Y) 13:00 – 13:59  
(Y) 02:00 – 02:59 15 (Y) 14:00 – 14:59  
(N) 03:00 – 03:59 16 (Y) 15:00 – 15:59  
(N) 04:00 – 04:59 17 (Y) 16:00 – 16:59  
(N) 05:00 – 05:59 18 (Y) 17:00 – 17:59  
(N) 06:00 – 06:59 19 (Y) 18:00 – 18:59  
(N) 07:00 – 07:59 20 (Y) 19:00 – 19:59  
(N) 08:00 – 08:59 21 (Y) 20:00 – 20:59  
10 (N) 09:00 – 09:59 22 (Y) 21:00 – 21:59  
11 (N) 10:00 – 10:59 23 (Y) 22:00 – 22:59  
12 (Y) 11:00 – 11:59 24 (Y) 23:00 – 23:59  
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓←→  
# OF PERIODS SET IN MEMORY  
This is the initial setting of the number of periods  
TIME PERIOD  
157  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Each Time period can be alterated from the defined time ranges providing now two time periods overlap, time  
periods can also be suppressed from printing.  
158  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
159  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                          
                          
                          
                          
                                                                                                                 
                                                                                                                 
EMPLOYEE  
The employee file contains information for register operators as well as employees who use  
the register only to clock in or out (employee time keeping.). Specific functions that are  
allowed or disallowed for each employee are determined by assigning the employee to an  
authority level.  
Two 10 digit code numbers may be assigned for each employee. A time keeping code is  
used to clock in or out and a separate sign on code used to operate the register. The social  
security number is for reference only and appears only on reports.  
EMPLOYEE# 1 PROGRAMMING  
L1  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. PLU  
1. NAME  
JOHN H  
2. PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. GROUP  
4. FUNCTION KEY  
5. SYSTEM OPTION  
6. TAXES  
2. SOCIAL SEC #  
ABCD000000000  
0000000101  
0000000001  
1
3. CLOCK IN CODE  
4. OPERATING CODE  
5. LINK TO AUTHORITY LEVEL  
JOB1 JOB2 JOB3 JOB4 JOB5 JOB6  
7. MESSAGES  
8. WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
9. TIME PERIOD  
6. JOB CODE# 01 02  
7. PAY RATE# 01 02  
8. OPEN DRAWER# (0-3)  
9. TRAINING MODE?  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00 00  
00 00  
0
10. EMPLOYEE  
N
11. AUTHORITY LEVEL  
12. PRINTER TABLES & KV ROUTING  
EDIT JOB CODES  
EDIT PAY RATES  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓←→  
JOB CODE PROGRAMMING  
ALPHA  
PAY RATE PROGRAMMING  
L1  
09.00  
JOB CODE1  
JOB CODE2  
JOB CODE3  
JOB CODE4  
JOB CODE5  
MANAGER  
PAY RATE1  
PAY RATE2  
PAY RATE3  
PAY RATE4  
PAY RATE5  
PAY RATE6  
PAY RATE7  
PAY RATE8  
PAY RATE9  
PAY RATE10  
PAY RATE11  
PAY RATE11  
WAITRESS  
BAR STAFF  
CHEF  
08.00  
07.00  
06.00  
05.00  
04.00  
03.60  
05.10  
05.20  
05.30  
05.40  
00.00  
RECEPTION  
JOB CODE6  
JOB CODE7  
JOB CODE8  
JOB CODE9  
JOB CODE10  
JOB CODE11  
JOB CODE12  
HOTEL  
GOLF CLUB  
POOL  
ADMISSION  
HYGEINE  
KITCHEN  
JOB#12  
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓←→  
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓←→  
160  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EMPLOYEE - DEFINITIONS  
EMPLOYEE #  
This is the sequential program code held by the system  
NAME  
This is the clerk name entry field  
SOCIAL SEC #  
This is a reference field for storing the employees official reference number  
CLOCK IN CODE  
This is the code used for time in/out wages calculations  
OPERATING CODE  
This is the code used for registration procedures.  
LINK TO AUTHORITY LEVEL  
Each employee can be linked to one of nine different security levels, defined by the authority program  
JOB CODE 1 - 6  
Each employee can perform up to six different jobs from waitress to bar manger. This code number is the  
reference number from the Job code file for the relevant job description  
PAY RATE 1 - 6  
Each of the six jobs being performed can be allocated from the pay rate table a different hourly rate, which is  
used for wages calculations  
OPEN DRAWER #  
This is the cash drawer, which the operator will be using  
TRAINING MODE?  
Training mode can be accessed via X-mode and appliplable to the whole machine or can be defined for one  
employee  
JOB CODE PROGRAM  
Job codes are used to break down the hours worked for all employees into different categories  
A breakdown of hours by job is also reported for each employee (The job codes to be used by all  
employees are set up here. There are 20 possible job codes. Each job code you wish to activate must  
be given a descriptor here.  
PAY RATE PROGRAM  
The pay rates to be used by all employees are set up here. There are 50 pay rates., each job code for  
each employee can be allocated a different pay rate  
161  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                     
                                                                     
                                                                   
                                                                   
↑↓←→  
AUTHORITY  
Each employee must be assigned to one of nine authority levels. The selections made here for each  
authority level determine the operations that are allowed for each employee.  
For example, in a restaurant an authority level with the descriptor kitchen help could be set  
to allow only clocking in/out, or an authority level with the descriptor owner could be set up to  
allow all functions. Other authority levels could be defined for servers, cashiers and  
managers that allow only the appropriate functions.  
NOTE: It is recommended when using authority the S-MODE system password is  
allocated.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. PLU  
2. PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. GROUP  
4. FUNCTION KEY  
5. SYSTEM OPTION  
6. TAXES  
7. MESSAGES  
8. WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
9. TIME PERIOD  
10. EMPLOYEE  
11. AUTHORITY LEVEL  
12. PRINTER TABLES & KV ROUTING  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
AUTHORITY LEVEL PROGRAMMING  
L1  
ALPHA DESCRIPTORS  
AUTHORITY LEVEL : 1 23 4 567 89  
1. CLOCK-IN/OUT ENTRY ONLY?  
NNNNNNNNN  
2. MUST CLOCK-IN BEFORE SALES? NNNNNNNNN  
3. CAN CLOCK-OUT IF OPEN CHKS? NNNNNNNNN  
4. GUEST CHECK ENTRIES ONLY?  
NNNNNNNNN  
5. GUEST# ENTRY ON NEW CHECKS?NNNNNNNNN  
6. PAYMENT OF OWN GUEST CHECK?NNNNNNNNN  
7. PAYMENT OF ANY GUEST CHECK? Y YYYY YYYY  
8. TRANSFER OF GUEST CHECKS? Y YYYY YYYY  
9. VOIDING OF SERVICED ITEMS?  
Y YYYY YYYY  
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
162  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTHORITY – DEFINITIONS  
LEVEL 1 - 9 DESCRIPTORS  
Each of the authority levels can be given a description for reference purposes.  
CLOCK-IN/OUT ENTRY ONLY  
This allows an employee solely to use the time clock feature  
MUST CLOCK-IN BEFORE SALES  
This forces an employee to clock in before any register sales can be made.  
CAN CLOCK-OUT IF OPEN CHKS  
This controls whether an employee can close a session with outstanding balances allocated to themselves still on  
a check.  
GUEST CHECK ENTRIES ONLY  
This provides a restriction on employees allowing them only to operate the check tracking system  
GUEST# ENTRY ON NEW CHECKS  
This forces the entry of a guest number on new checks  
PAYMENT OF OWN GUEST CHECK  
This provides restriction allowing employees only to receive payment of checks opened by them  
PAYMENT OF ANY GUEST CHECK  
This provides restriction allowing employees only to receive payment of any checks opened  
TRANSFER OF GUEST CHECKS  
This provides a restriction for the transfer of check details between employees  
VOIDING OF SERVICED ITEMS  
This allows control of voids within a check tracking system  
ALLOW CANCEL AFTER RECALL  
This allows an employee to use cancel with checks and clerk interrupt sales the currently entered sale  
CLOCK IN/OUT USING MCR  
Determines whether time in/out can be carried out using the MCR (Magnetic Card Reader)  
SIGN IN/OUT USING MCR  
Determines whether employee sign on can be carried out using the MCR (Magnetic Card Reader)  
163  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTHORITY – DEFINITIONS  
ALLOW EDIT ANY CHECKS  
This allows the employee access to any open checks with no restriction to just those opened exclusively by that  
employee  
ALLOW DESTINATION CHANGE  
This allows the transfer of checks, movement of check numbers  
CAN COMBINE OWN SOFT CHKS  
This controls the add check feature, allowing the operator to add their own checks for payment  
CAN COMBINE ANY SOFT CHKS  
This controls access to the add check feature, allowing the operator to add any checks for payment  
TABLE # TRANSFER IN R-MODE  
This controls whether it is possible to change the allocated table number within the register mode  
CAN PLU PRC/HALO OVERRIDE  
This controls whether the pre-set prices and maximum limits of the items can be overridden  
ALLOW SET DATE AND TIME  
This controls access to the X mode date and time programming option  
ALLOW TIME CLOCK EDIT  
This control access to the X mode time in/out information edit option  
ALLOW CASH DECLARATION  
This controls access to the X mode cash declaration option  
ALLOW K/B AND PRICE LEVEL  
This determines whether the user can change the price level the system is operating, also the ability to change  
product keyboard menu levels.  
ALLOW EMPLOYEE FILE EDIT  
The programming of the employee file can be restricted  
ALLOW PRINT & RESET OF E.J.  
This provides control for the electronic journal reporting  
164  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
165  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTHORITY – DEFINITIONS  
ALLOW JOB CODE EDIT  
This provides control over employee labour job description programming and amendments  
ALLOW PAY RATE EDIT  
This provides control over employee labour hourly pay rate programming and amendments  
CAN INVENTORY EDIT X MODE  
This provides control over as to where the inventory stock can be accessed for amendments  
CAN INVENTORY EDIT P MODE  
This provides control over as to where the inventory stock can be accessed for amendments  
COMP. SEAT# FOR EACH ENTRY  
This forces a seat number to be entered for all check sales, for the breakdown of the products sold within the  
check for payment of the items per seat at final payment  
ENABLE TRAINING MODE  
Access to the X mode training option can be restricted  
ALLOW WLU FILE EDIT  
This allows restriction to the Window Look Unit menu programming  
ALLOW NO SALE  
This provides restriction for the no sale function operation  
PAID BREAKS  
This determines whether when an employee has clock out for a break whether time is paid as part of wage  
costing.  
MANAGER REQ. FOR CLOCK IN  
This only allows clock in to take place in the X Manager Control mode.  
COMPULSORY TIP ENTRY  
This forces the operator to enter a tip amount as they clock out of the system  
JOB CODE CHANGE  
This controls whether an employee is allowed to change the designated job description and allocated pay rate  
ALLOW PLU PRC CHANGE ONLY  
The program mode can be restricted so the operator can only program product prices  
166  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                             
                             
↑↓  
PRINTER TABLES AND KV ROUTING  
The printing system of an SPS 1000 register or system of registers is completely flexible. Up to 40  
printers can be defined and connected to any available serial port on any register within a system.  
Multiple printer functions can be assigned to the same printer, giving added flexibility. Before  
programming here, you must  
See "Serial Port Device Selections" in S-Mode Programming to define the type of device that is  
connected  
See "Define Serial Port Parameters" in S-Mode Programming to match the baud rate/parity/etc.  
between the serial port and the printer. This program also controls the feed lines before and after  
printing, the logo size, and cutting options.  
See "Printer Driver Selections" if you are using a printer other than the printers with predefined  
drivers, or if you need to customize a driver for a printer.  
Next, assign a port for each printer, assign printer number (1-40), give it a 10 character descriptor  
(i.e. salad prep, receipt, or detail) and identify the port # and the register # to which it is attached.  
In addition, you can identify a back-up location for information designated to go to the printer.  
Finally, proceed with the parts of this program that pertain to your application:  
Because it is sometimes necessary to change kitchen printer routing depending upon the time of  
the day, (for example, separate hot and cold food kitchens may be active during lunch and a single  
kitchen active during dinner) you can make assignments for four different periods. The active  
routing period can be controlled automatically Routing can also be allocated to be activated  
centrally using one master terminal or each terminal independent  
PRINTER & KV ROUTING MENU  
L1  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
1. SYSTEM PRINTER CONFIGURATION  
2. KITCHEN VIDEO ROUTING  
3. KITCHEN PRINTER ROUTING  
4. RECEIPT PRINTER ROUNTING  
5. DETAIL PRINTER ROUTING  
1. PLU  
2. PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. GROUP  
4. FUNCTION KEY  
5. SYSTEM OPTION  
6. TAXES  
7. MESSAGES  
8. WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
9. TIME PERIOD  
10. EMPLOYEE  
11. AUTHORITY LEVEL  
12. PRINTER TABLES & KV ROUTING  
!
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓  
SYSTEM PRINTER CONFIGURATION  
Every printer used within the system must be allocated a printer number within this menu option  
KITCHEN VIDEO ROUTING  
The video display system must be activate within this menu option  
KITCHEN PRINTER ROUTING  
Each route required for printing must be allocated a printer number within this menu option  
RECEIPT PRINTER ROUTING  
Each receipt printer within the system must be allocated within this menu option  
DETAIL PRINTER ROUTING  
Each detailed journal printer within the system must be allocated within this menu option  
167  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                          
                                                           
SYSTEM PRINTER CONFIGURATION  
Used to assign a port for each printer. Then assign printer number (1-40), give it a 10 character  
descriptor (i.e. salad prep, receipt, or detail) and identify the port # and the register # to which it is  
attached. In addition, you can identify a back-up location for information designated to go to the  
printer. (For example, if the salad printer is not functioning, then could be sent to a different printer.)  
SYSTEM PRINTER CONFIGURATION  
MAIN  
ALPHA  
BACKUP  
PRINTER DESCRIPTOR REG#-PORT# REG#-PORT#  
------------- ------------------- ------------------ -------------------  
# 1  
# 2  
# 3  
# 4  
# 5  
# 6  
# 7  
# 8  
# 9  
#10  
RCPT TILL1  
DETL TILL1  
RCPT TILL2  
DETL TILL2  
KITCHEN 1  
01-2  
01-1  
02-2  
02-1  
02-1  
00-0  
00-0  
00-0  
00-0  
00-0  
02-2  
02-1  
01-2  
01-1  
00-0  
00-0  
00-0  
00-0  
00-0  
00-0  
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
PRINTER NO.  
This is a sequential number generated by the system that will be used to refer to the printer throughout  
the system  
DESCRIPTOR  
This is a description of the task the printer will be carrying out i.e. Receipt-till 1, KP-till 2  
REG#-PORT# MAIN  
This is the register number and the physical port number on that register the printer is connected to.  
This is the MAIN output which will be used under normal circumstances  
REG#-PORT# BACKUP  
This is the register number and the physical port number on that register the printer is connected to.  
This is the Backup output which will be used when there is no access to the normal route  
168  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
KITCHEN VIDEO ROUTING  
Use Kitchen Video Routing to define the location of the video controller. If you wish to  
designate a backup printer, in the event that the video system in not operational, enter the  
location of the back-up here.  
KITCHEN VIDEO ROUTING  
MAIN  
ALPHA  
BACKUP  
VIDEO# DESCRIPTOR REG#-PORT# PRINTER#  
----------- ------------------- ------------------- --------------  
#1  
VIDEO 1  
01-2  
00  
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓←→  
VIDEO #  
This is a sequential number generated by the system that will be used to refer to the video throughout  
the system  
DESCRIPTOR  
This is a description of the task the video will be carrying out i.e. Main Bar 1, Kitchen 2.  
REG#-PORT# MAIN  
This is the register number and the physical port number on the register that the video is connected to.  
This is the MAIN output, which will be used under normal circumstances  
PRINTER# BACKUP  
This is the system printer number(0 - 40) on the register. This is the Backup output, which will be used  
when there is no access to the normal route  
169  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                           
                                                                           
KITCHEN PRINTER ROUTING  
The kitchen printing can be controlled in various ways, There are four pages of printing which can be allocated,  
each page can be changed, allowing products to print in different areas, depeding on certain criteria. The four  
pages can be changed automatically as a time functions, sale type related using the three analysis keys, or  
operator definable using the KP routing key. The current page/period for printing can optionally be displayed in  
register. There is also the added network control of the system running four pages for the whole network or four  
pages per terminal, with optionally a centrally controlled order number, or a number relating to each register, all  
these setting are controlled by program mode system options  
KITCHEN PRINTER ROUTING  
PERIOD#1  
PT DESCRPTOR KP KP KP KP KP KP KP KP KP  
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
---- ------------------- ---- ---- ---- ---- ----- ---- ---- ---- ----  
05 KITCHEN 1  
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓←→  
PERIOD#1  
The system has four periods for kitchen printing, these can be timed so that as areas open and close  
the printed information is redirected. For example the restaurant will only be opening in the evenings  
therefore during the day all food receipts are to be printed in the bar with a timed switch when the  
restaurant opens in the evening. However the most common instance is one period. Depeding on  
wether the termianl is program for a system set of four periods or indpendatly per machine, will  
determine wether the register number field appears on the display allow programm of each period per  
termianl.  
PT #  
This is the number of the printer and is crossed reference with the networks master list of printers set  
in system printer configuration which controls the output and termianl connections.  
KP #  
Each set of products is linked to a kitchen printer group using the PLU status groups i.e. setting a group for  
drinks and one for food. This group number is then set to be printer on the required printer. For exmaple during  
the day the bar printer may print both group 1 drinks and group 2 food, which would be set to period on then  
during the evening the food may be printed on a different printer in the kitchen this would be set in period 2  
Eg Period 1  
Period 2  
Printer 1 Bar Printer set to print 1,2  
Printer 1 Bar Printer set to print 1 and  
Printer 2 Food Printer set to print 2  
then  
170  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                  
                                                                  
RECEIPT PRINTER ROUTING  
This controls the routing of the receipt printer, defining which terminal the printer is connected to, this is  
master list for the whole of the network.  
RECEIPT PRINTER ROUTING  
L1  
REGISTER# PRINTER# REGISTER# PRINTER#  
----------------- --------------- ----------------- ---------------  
01  
02  
01  
02  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓←→  
REGISTER #  
This is the register number that requires a receipt printer, all registers must be allocated within this  
section  
PRINTER #  
This is the printer number allocated in system printer configuration that is to be used. The information will then  
be routed down the channel which was configured in that section  
171  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                      
                                                                      
DETAIL PRINTER ROUTING  
This controls the routing of the journal printer defining which terminal the printer is connected to. This is  
a master list for the whole of the network.  
DETAIL PRINTER ROUTING  
L1  
REGISTER# PRINTER# REGISTER# PRINTER#  
----------------- --------------- ----------------- ---------------  
01  
02  
01  
02  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
00 00  
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓←→  
REGISTER #  
This is the register number that requires a detailed journal printer, all registers must be allocated within  
this section  
PRINTER #  
This is the printer number allocated in system printer configuration that is to be used. The information will then  
be routed down the channel which was configured in that section  
172  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                             
                             
                                                                                                                   
                                                                                                                   
INGREDIENT INVENTORY  
A menu-explosion type inventory system is set up when PLUs are linked to a Recipe# and  
recipes are then programmed with a list of ingredients. Use X-MODE MANAGER MENU to  
receive, transfer in/out, or enter raw waste for ingredients in this system.  
NOTE: Be careful not to confuse the separate and distinct inventory features  
Recipes and Ingredients – Stock control of components making up a saleable product  
Product Mix Groups usage analysis of a group of saleable products  
PLU Stock – Stock control of saleable products  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
INGREDIENT INVENTORY MENU  
L1  
13. INGREDIENT INVENTORY  
14. TIME ACTIVATED FUNCTIONS  
15. PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
16. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
17. CUSTOM REPORT  
1. EDIT INGREDIENT  
2. RECEIPT TABLE  
18. STRING REPORT  
19. PLU STOCK  
20. PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
21. COPY PROGRAM  
22. PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
23. P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
24. NON-PLU CODE  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
"
ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
INGREDIENT PROGRAMMING  
ALPHA  
RECIPE# 1 PROGRAMMING  
DESCRIPTOR  
ALPHA  
INGREDIENT#  
DESCRIPTOR  
COST  
BURGER&SALAD  
--------------------  
----------------------- ------------  
ING/RECIPE  
#
DESCRIPTOR QTY  
001  
002  
003  
004  
005  
006  
007  
008  
009  
010  
BURGER  
BREAD BUN  
RELISH PACK  
000.120  
000.060  
000.100  
000.000  
000.000  
000.000  
000.000  
000.000  
000.000  
000.000  
------------------- ------ ---------------------- ------  
01 INGREDIENT 01 BURGER  
02 INGREDIENT 02 BREAD BUN  
002  
001  
03  
RECIPE 04 SIDE SALAD  
001  
04 INGREDIENT 00  
05 INGREDIENT 00  
06 INGREDIENT 00  
07 INGREDIENT 00  
08 INGREDIENT 00  
09 INGREDIENT 00  
10 INGREDIENT 00  
000  
000  
000  
000  
000  
000  
000  
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓←→  
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓←→  
173  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INGREDIENT – DEFINITIONS  
It is possible to program a list of ingredients, which can then be linked to create a recipe.  
This recipe is then allocated to a PLU number. This ensures that when the PLU is sold, the  
stock is deducted from the relevant ingredients by the appropriate quantities  
EDIT INGREDIENT  
This is where all the ingredients are allocated. These ingredients are independent of the PLU file  
INGREDIENT #  
The first section is the sequential ingredient reference number  
DESCRIPTOR  
This is the description of the ingredient  
COST  
This is the cost of the ingredient to the smallest possible usage i.e. gram, etc. that will be required within a recipe  
you would enter 8 for a 1/2lb steak.  
RECIPE TABLE  
It is possible to link ingredients together to form a complete menu. Recipes can also be  
linked to other recipes to form a more comprehensive inventory. i.e. side salad recipe can be  
linked to steak recipe  
NUMBER  
The first section is the sequential recipe reference number  
ING/RECIPE  
This indicates whether the item to be entered is from the ingredient file or is already created as recipe ready to be  
included into this recipe  
#
This is either the ingredient number or the recipe number depending on the ING/RECIPE answer, Pressing  
DONE here will provide a list of either ingredients or recipes for selection  
DESCRIPTOR  
This automatically displays the description related to the code number entered as an ingredient  
QTY  
This is the quantity of the ingredient to be updated when the relevant PLU linked to this recipe is sold.  
Ingredients should be programmed in the lowest possible usage i.e. grams and this quantity used to allocate the  
number of small components i.e. 10 grams  
174  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TIME ACTIVATED PROGRAM  
It is possible to automate a number of functions in order to provide a complete system  
management, levels can be changed, reports run, printer re-routed etc..  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
13. INGREDIENT INVENTORY  
14. TIME ACTIVATED FUNCTIONS  
15. PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
16. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
17. CUSTOM REPORT  
18. STRING REPORT  
19. PLU STOCK  
20. PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
21. COPY PROGRAM  
22. PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
23. P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
24. NON-PLU CODE  
"
ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
TIME ACTIVATED FUNCTIONS MENU  
L1  
1. KEYBOARD LEVELS  
2. PRICE LEVELS  
3. MACROS  
4. STRING REPORTS  
5. SHIFTS  
6. KP TIME PERIOD  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓  
175  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TIME ACTIVATED – KEYBOARD LEVELS  
This automates the change of menu level keys at specific times, on specific days, reverting  
back when the next keyboard level is timed to commence.  
TIME ACTIVATE KEYBOARD LEVEL#1  
L1  
99:99  
ACTIVATE AT (99:99 = DISABLED)  
WEEK : SUN MON TUE WED THU FRI SAT  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓←→  
KEYBOARD LEVEL  
This switches the default keyboard level to that selected  
LEVEL #  
This is the keyboard level 1 - 5 that is to be automated  
ACTIVATE AT (99:99 = DISABLED)  
This is the time when the menu level is to switch from default to the LEVEL# no end time is required and the  
switch back again will also be programmed as an activated time change  
WEEK : SUN ETC.  
Days of the week can be included and excluded as required from this menu switch  
176  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TIME ACTIVATED – PRICE LEVELS  
This automates the change to any of the twenty ‘price sets’ at specific times, on specific days,  
reverting back when the next price level is timed to commence.  
TIME ACTIVATE PRICE LEVEL# 1  
L1  
99:99  
ACTIVATE AT (99:99 = DISABLED)  
WEEK : SUN MON TUE WED THU FRI SAT  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓←→  
PRICE LEVEL  
This switches the default price level to that selected  
LEVEL #  
This is the price level 1 - 20 that is to be automated  
ACTIVATE AT (99:99 = DISABLED)  
This is the time when the price level is to switch from default to the PRICE LEVEL# no end time is required and  
the switch back again will also be programmed as an activated time change  
WEEK : SUN ETC.  
Days of the week can be included and excluded as required from price switch  
177  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TIME ACTIVATED – MACRO KEYS  
This automates, the macro keys which in turn run a sequence of function key presses. These run at  
specific times on specific days, reverting back when the next keyboard level is times to commence.  
NOTE: When using automated key macros it is advisable to ensure that the P-mode  
system flag which prevents macros running in a continuous loop is turned on.  
TIME ACTIVATE MACRO# 1  
L1  
99:99  
ACTIVATE AT (99:99 = DISABLED)  
REPEAT EVERY MINUTES(0 = NO REPEAT) 000  
WEEK : SUN MON TUE WED THU FRI SAT  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓←→  
MACROS  
There are pre-programmed key sequences stored as macro, the automation will activate the sequence allocated to  
the macro key 1 - 40 that is selected.  
MACRO#  
This is the macro key number to be automated  
ACTIVATE AT (99:99 = DISABLED)  
This is the time when the function is to be activated  
REPEAT EVERY MINUTES (0 = NO REPEAT)  
It is possible to repeat the function every few minutes. This form a continuous loop, it is therefore imperative you  
are aware of the actions to be carried out.  
WEEK : SUN ETC.  
Days of the week can be included and excluded as required from this automation  
178  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TIME ACTIVATED – STRING REPORTS  
This automates the reporting, running a pre-designed collection of reports at specific times, on  
specific days.  
TIME ACTIVATE STRING REPORT#1  
L1  
99:99  
ACTIVATE AT (99:99 = DISABLED)  
REPEAT EVERY MINUTES (0 = NO REPEAT) 000  
WEEK : SUN MON TUE WED THU FRI SAT  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
IRC OPTION :  
REG# ISSUES IRC STRING REPORT  
STANDALONE  
00  
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓←→  
STRING REPORTS  
It is possible to timed reports by combining the relevant reports and selecting a report type in the string report  
programming  
STRING REPORT#  
This is the report number to be automated  
ACTIVATE AT (99:99 = DISABLED)  
This is the time when the report is to be activated  
REPEAT EVERY MINUTES (0 = NO REPEAT)  
It is possible to repeat the function every few minutes. This form a continuous loop, it is therefore imperative you  
are aware of the actions to be carried out.  
WEEK : SUN ETC.,  
Days of the week can be included and excluded as required from this automation  
179  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TIME ACTIVATED – SHIFTS  
This automates the switch to the next shift reporting period, commencing a new report this happens at  
up to four specific times per day.  
SHIFT TIME PROGRAMMING  
ALPHA  
SHIFT DESCRIPTOR START/END TIME  
-------- ----------------------- -------------------------  
1
2
3
4
MORNING  
LUNCH  
AFTERNOON  
EVENING  
09:00 – 10:59  
11:00 – 12:59  
13:00 – 15:59  
16:00 – 23:00  
TTL  
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓←→  
SHIFT  
The system has a shift report comprising of 4 shifts. A new shift can be activated manually or automated. This  
will start a new period of financial storage.  
DESCRIPTOR  
This is enables a name to be allocated to each shift.  
START TIME FOR EACH OF THE FOUR PERIODS  
This is the time the shift commences  
END TIME FOR EACH OF THE FOUR PERIODS  
This is the time the shift ends  
180  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TIME ACTIVATED – KITCHEN PRINTING  
Because it is sometimes necessary to change kitchen printer routing depending upon the  
time of the day, (for example, separate hot and cold food kitchens may be active during  
lunch and a single kitchen active during dinner) you can make assignments for four different  
periods. The active routing period can be controlled automatically Routing can also be  
allocated to be activated centrally using one master terminal or each terminal independent. If  
kitchen printing changes are not required to be timed, the routing can be changed in reigster  
using either one of the thress analysis keys or the KP routing key.  
KP TIME PERIOD PROGRAMMING  
L1  
PERIOD  
START/END TIME  
-----------  
--------------------------  
09:00 – 10:59  
1
2
3
4
11:00 – 12:59  
13:00 – 15:59  
16:00 – 23:00  
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓←→  
KP TIME PERIOD  
It is possible to switch what kitchen printers are in use, and change the routing of products depending on the time  
of day. The four periods are allocated in printer programming with the appropriate printers and then the  
following automation can be programmed  
START TIME FOR EACH OF THE FOUR PERIODS  
This is the time the switch to a different kitchen period will change  
END TIME FOR EACH OF THE FOUR PERIODS  
This is the time the switch to the new range of kitchen printer will end.  
181  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
182  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                          
                          
PRODUCT MIX GROUPS PROGRAM  
Product mix groups can be used to program each product with a piece cout usage of a case,  
with the product group defining how many units are in each outer. This will then provide  
reporting on how many units and case have been used per group, per time period with  
option seven day, four week projections  
NOTE: Be careful not to confuse the separate and distinct inventory features of the  
SPS 1000:  
Recipes and Ingredients – Stock control of components making up a saleable product  
Product Mix Groups usage analysis of a group of saleable products  
PLU Stock – Stock control of saleable products  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
PRODUCT MIX GROUPS MENU  
L1  
13. INGREDIENT INVENTORY  
14. TIME ACTIVATED FUNCTIONS  
15. PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
16. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
17. CUSTOM REPORT  
1. PRODUCT MIX ITEMS  
2. PRODUCT MIX GROUP TIME PERIODS  
18. STRING REPORT  
19. PLU STOCK  
20. PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
21. COPY PROGRAM  
22. PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
23. P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
24. NON-PLU CODE  
"
ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓  
PRODUCT MIX ITEM PROGRAMMING ALPHA  
PRODUCT MIX TIME PERIOD PROGRAMMING L1  
# OF PERIODS SET IN MEMORY : 24  
ITEM# DESCRIPTOR PCS/UNIT UNIT DESC  
-------- ----------------------- ------------- ----------------  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
(Y) 00:00 – 00:59 13 (Y) 12:00 – 12:59  
(Y) 01:00 – 01:59 14 (Y) 13:00 – 13:59  
(Y) 02:00 – 02:59 15 (Y) 14:00 – 14:59  
(N) 03:00 – 03:59 16 (Y) 15:00 – 15:59  
(N) 04:00 – 04:59 17 (Y) 16:00 – 16:59  
(N) 05:00 – 05:59 18 (Y) 17:00 – 17:59  
(N) 06:00 – 06:59 19 (Y) 18:00 – 18:59  
(N) 07:00 – 07:59 20 (Y) 19:00 – 19:59  
(N) 08:00 – 08:59 21 (Y) 20:00 – 20:59  
001 BRANDY  
002 TETLEY DRAUG 016  
032  
BOTT  
1 / 2s  
003 BOT BECKS  
024  
000  
000  
000  
000  
000  
000  
000  
CASE  
004  
005  
006  
007  
008  
009  
010  
10 (N) 09:00 – 09:59 22 (Y) 21:00 – 21:59  
11 (N) 10:00 – 10:59 23 (Y) 22:00 – 22:59  
12 (N) 11:00 – 11:59 24 (Y) 23:00 – 23:59  
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓←→  
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓←→  
183  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PRODUCT MIX GROUPS– DEFINITIONS  
Product mix groups are used to track the usage of specific items in addition to the major groups.  
There is also reporting information provided by the product mix groups that is superior to other group  
reporting. With product mix groups, you can also assign a piece count / inventory usage values to  
each PLU. This ensures when a product is sold, the product mix group is updated with the appropriate  
quantity in the piece count. This usage information is used to provide hourly inventory usage of  
selected products, also providing the memory allocation has been set with the projection on.  
PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
ITEM#  
This is a sequential product mix group number  
DESCRIPTOR  
This is description of the item to be tracked i.e. beef burgers  
PCS/UNIT  
This is the number of items in a case i.e. 12 burgers per case  
UNIT DESC  
This is the description of the case i.e. 12 Burgers are a DOZEN  
RELEVANT PLU PROGRAMMING  
PIECE COUNT  
This is the number of items used from the product group pack i.e. the number of bottles in a case, the number of  
burgers in a box  
PRODUCT MIX#  
This is the link to group i.e. all PLUs using burgers would be linked to the product mix group, or a group would  
be set for each type of bottle beer.  
PRODUCT MIX TIME PERIOD  
Memory allocation determines whether there are 24-Hourly, 48-Half Hourly or 96 - 15mins product mix time  
periods. Periods can be set to custom lengths using the program. If fewer periods are needed than are available,  
then the unused deactivated, using the Y/N toggle.  
184  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                                                                   
                                                                                                                   
↑↓  
MIX & MATCH TABLE PROGRAM  
This is used to automate promotional discounts, each table is linked to one or many PLU  
items activating such features as ‘buy one get one free’ etc…  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
MIX & MATCH TABLE PROGRAMMING ALPHA  
13. INGREDIENT INVENTORY  
14. TIME ACTIVATED FUNCTIONS  
15. PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
16. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
17. CUSTOM REPORT  
TBL#  
DESCRIPTOR TRIP LVL  
PRICE  
------- ------------------------ ------------- --------------  
001  
002  
003  
004  
005  
006  
007  
008  
009  
010  
BUY 1 GET 1  
DISCOUNT#2  
DISCOUNT#3  
DISCOUNT#4  
DISCOUNT#5  
DISCOUNT#6  
DISCOUNT#7  
DISCOUNT#8  
DISCOUNT#9  
DISCOUNT#10  
01  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
000001.99  
000000.00  
000000.00  
000000.00  
000000.00  
000000.00  
000000.00  
000000.00  
000000.00  
000000.00  
18. STRING REPORT  
19. PLU STOCK  
20. PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
21. COPY PROGRAM  
22. PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
23. P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
24. NON-PLU CODE  
"
ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
!
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
TBL#  
This is the mix and match table number, this will be allocated to the PLU products to activate the discount  
DESCRIPTOR  
This is the discount description that will be printed on the sales receipts, indicating the reason for the discount i.e.  
2 for 1, or Buy one get one free  
TRIP LVL  
This is the number of PLU products allocated to this table this must be sold before the discount is given  
PRICE  
This is the value of money to be discounted from the sales total  
185  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                                                                       
                                                                                                                       
CUSTOM REPORT  
CUSTOM REPORTS PROGRAMMING  
One custom report can be created, with up to 50 totals and counters. The report is built by  
selecting totals that also appear on other register reports. When the custom report is  
created, totals and counters separate from the original report are also created (in other  
words, you can clear either the custom independently without affecting totals in any other  
report.)  
Another feature of the custom report is the ability to add or subtract selected totals to create  
a new subtotal of selected information.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
13. INGREDIENT INVENTORY  
14. TIME ACTIVATED FUNCTIONS  
15. PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
16. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
17. CUSTOM REPORT  
18. STRING REPORT  
19. PLU STOCK  
20. PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
21. COPY PROGRAM  
22. PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
23. P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
24. NON-PLU CODE  
"
ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
REPORT PROGRAMMING  
L1  
CUSTOM REPORT PROGRAMMING  
RPT TTL  
L1  
#
#
#
RED  
+/-  
DESCRIPTOR  
1. CUSTOM REPORT  
---- ------ ----- ------ ------------- ----------------------  
2. EDIT EXISTING REPORTS  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
001 N + ( ADD ) +PLU LVL1 TTL  
003 N + ( ADD ) +PLU LVL2 TTL  
998 N NONADD (DASHIED LINE)  
999 N NONADD PLU TOTAL  
000 N NONADD  
000 N NONADD  
000 N NONADD  
000 N NONADD  
000 N NONADD  
000 N NONADD  
ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
!
DONE:LIST ESC ENT PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓←→  
186  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOM REPORT - DEFINITIONS  
RPT#  
This is the report number to be used. The report numbers can be found on the X/Z menus  
TTL#  
This is the totaliser from the report i.e. Report 1 financial total 1 (line 1) +PLU LVL 1 TTL  
999 - Provides a custom subtotal line 998 - Prints a dashed line separator  
RED  
Print in RED providing the printer has red black capabilities  
+ / -  
This is used to indicate if the total on this line is to be added or subtracted to create a new subtotal. When the  
TTL# code i.e. 999 is entered on a later line. Previous totals with are + / - designation are added and printed. 998  
Prints a dashed lined across the report.  
DESCRIPTOR  
This is the default description of the totaliser selected, this can be changed if required  
Note: Use the total #998 to create a dashed separator line on the report.  
Use the total #999 to create a subtotal line.  
The subtotal line will calculate the totals designated "+" or "-" that appear  
sequentially after the previous subtotal line. Enter a custom descriptor for the  
subtotal line.  
187  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOM REPORT – EDIT EXISTING REPORTS  
EDIT EXISTING REPORTS  
It is possible to determine whether information is printed in black or printed in red on existing financial and  
employee reports. This works in-conjunction with the zero skip system flag.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
13. INGREDIENT INVENTORY  
14. TIME ACTIVATED FUNCTIONS  
15. PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
16. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
17. CUSTOM REPORT  
18. STRING REPORT  
19. PLU STOCK  
20. PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
21. COPY PROGRAM  
22. PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
23. P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
24. NON-PLU CODE  
"
ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
REPORT PROGRAM  
L1  
EDIT FINANCIAL REPORT  
TTL# DESCRIPTOR  
L1  
1. CUSTOM REPORT  
2. EDIT EXISTING REPORTS  
PRINT? RED?  
------- ----------------------------- ----------  
-------  
001  
N
+PLU LVL1 TTL  
Y
002  
003  
N
004  
005  
N
006  
007  
N
-PLU LVL1 TTL  
+PLU LVL2 TTL  
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
1. FINANCIAL REPORT  
2. EMPLOYEE REPORT  
-PLU LVL2 TTL  
+PLU LVL3 TTL  
N
Y
-PLU LVL3 TTL  
+PLU LVL4 TTL  
N
Y
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓  
008  
-PLU LVL4 TTL  
N
PRINT ?  
This determines if the field will be printed on the report it is a Yes / No option  
RED ?  
This determines whether the field will print RED (providing the printer has Red/Black capabilities  
188  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                           
                                                                           
STRING REPORT  
It is possible to group reports together so that all information is printed at once when the  
design report is selected from the reporting menu.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
13. INGREDIENT INVENTORY  
14. TIME ACTIVATED FUNCTIONS  
15. PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
16. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
17. CUSTOM REPORT  
18. STRING REPORT  
19. PLU STOCK  
20. PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
21. COPY PROGRAM  
22. PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
23. P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
24. NON-PLU CODE  
"
ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
STRING REPORT#1 PROGRAMMING  
DESCRIPTOR STRING REPORT #1  
RPT LVL  
( 1 - 5 ) RPT# DESCRIPTOR  
--- ------------ ------------ ------- ------------------------  
L1  
#
X/Z  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
!
Z
Z
2
2
0
0
0
0
0
0
01 FINANCIAL  
02 SALES BY TIME  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
0
0
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓←→  
189  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STRING REPORT - DEFINITIONS  
STRING REPORT #  
This is the number of the report to be programmed  
X/Z  
This determines what type of report is to be printed X - Read, Z-Reset or current, depending on the position of  
the mode lock at that time.  
RPT LEVEL  
This relates to the reporting area any one of the five can be selected for reporting  
RPT#  
This is the report number to be printed  
DESCRIPTOR  
This is the name of the report to be printed  
190  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLU STOCK ENTRY  
PLU stock is a simple inventory system where each whole unit PLU activity subtracts a value  
of "1" from the stock counter. he quantity modifer and stock link PLU programming can be  
used to link together two products so stock is reduced from one item with decimal quantity  
reduction if requird.  
PLU stock applies only to PLUs that are assigned to a PLU status group with the Stock  
PLU? setting set to Y Select PLU STOCK to maintain stock levels on PLUs selected for  
stock unit inventory.  
NOTE: Be careful not to confuse the separate and distinct inventory features  
Recipes and Ingredients – Stock control of components making up a saleable product  
Product Mix Groups usage analysis of a group of saleable products  
PLU Stock – Stock control of saleable products  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
PLU STOCK MENU  
L1  
13. INGREDIENT INVENTORY  
14. TIME ACTIVATED FUNCTIONS  
15. PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
16. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
17. CUSTOM REPORT  
1. ADD  
2. OVERRIDE  
3. SUBTRACT  
18. STRING REPORT  
19. PLU STOCK  
20. PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
21. COPY PROGRAM  
22. PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
23. P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
24. NON-PLU CODE  
"
ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓  
PLU#000000000000000000 STOCK(ADD)  
•PRESS THE PLU TO BE PROGRAMMED  
OR  
PLU#000000000000000001 STOCK(ADD)  
DESCRIPTOR :  
STOCK  
BOTTLE BECKS  
0.00  
•ENTER THE PLU NUMBER AND PRESS ENTER  
OR  
•ENTER THE PLU NUMBER AND PRESS PLU#  
PLU# ESC ENTER INDIVIDUAL PLU  
PLU# ESC Y/N ENT PAGE UP/DN
↓←→  
191  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLU STOCK ENTRY - DEFINITIONS  
PLU STOCK MENU  
ADD  
This adds to the existing stock figures. Used for deliveries transfers in etc..  
SUBTRACT  
This subtracts for the existing stock figures, Used for Returns, transfers out etc.  
OVERRIDE  
This overrides the existing stock figures. Used for beginning inventory etc..  
PLU STOCK ENTRY  
PLU#  
This is the product code number of the item to be allocated a minimum stock  
DESCRIPTOR  
This is the product description of the item to be allocated a minimum stock  
STOCK  
This is the current stock situation and the value now to be adjusted  
192  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLU MINIMUM STOCK PROGRAM  
Each product which is defined as a ‘Stock PLU’ can be allocated with a minimum stock figure once  
the products stock holding falls below this level, the item will then be available for print on the  
Minimum Stock report. This feature assists with the re-ordering of stock  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
13. INGREDIENT INVENTORY  
14. TIME ACTIVATED FUNCTIONS  
15. PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
16. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
17. CUSTOM REPORT  
18. STRING REPORT  
19. PLU STOCK  
20. PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
21. COPY PROGRAM  
22. PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
23. P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
24. NON-PLU CODE  
"
ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
PLU#000000000000000000 MIN.STOCK PROGRAM  
•PRESS THE PLU TO BE PROGRAMMED  
OR  
PLU#000000000000000001 MIN.STOCK PGM  
DESCRIPTOR :  
BOTTLE BECKS  
0.00  
MINIMUM STOCK  
•ENTER THE PLU NUMBER AND PRESS ENTER  
OR  
•ENTER THE PLU NUMBER AND PRESS PLU#  
PLU# ESC ENTER INDIVIDUAL PLU  
PLU# ESC Y/N ENT PAGE UP/DN
↓←→  
PLU#  
This is the product code number of the item to be allocated a minimum stock  
DESCRIPTOR  
This is the product description of the item to be allocated a minimum stock  
MINIMUM STOCK  
193  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This is quantity of units that are required as a minimum when the value falls below this level the item will be  
shown on a minimum stock report indicating re-order is required.  
194  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
195  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
COPY PROGRAM  
This function allows you to duplicate programs for :  
PLUs  
PLU Status Groups  
WLUs  
Keyboard Levels  
For example, all program options for one PLU can be duplicated on another PLU.  
NOTE: See “If General Function Option “ALLOW PLU COPY BY RANGE” is set to “Y”, then  
the options from one PLU or PLU Status Group can be copied to a range of PLUs or PLU  
Status Groups. If the option is set to “N” then the options from an individual PLU or PLU  
Status Group can be copied only to another individual PLU or PLU Status Group.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
13. INGREDIENT INVENTORY  
14. TIME ACTIVATED FUNCTIONS  
15. PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
16. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
17. CUSTOM REPORT  
18. STRING REPORT  
19. PLU STOCK  
20. PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
21. COPY PROGRAM  
22. PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
23. P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
24. NON-PLU CODE  
"
ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
COPY PROGRAM  
L1  
1. COPY PLU  
2. COPY PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. COPY KEYBOARD LEVEL  
4. COPY WLU  
FROM PLU #  
: 000000000000000000  
TO PLU RANGE : 000000000000000000  
- 000000000000000000  
ESC ENTER  
196  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
COPY PROGRAM - DEFINITIONS  
COPY PLU  
Used to copy the information held against an individual PLU to another saving time and energy on repetitive  
programming. This can be done singularly i.e. one PLU to another or by enabling the system flag PLU copy by  
range, from one PLU to a range of other PLUS  
COPY PLU STATUS GROUP  
Used to copy the information held against an individual PLU Program STATUS GROUP to another range of  
groups. This saves both time and energy on repetitive programming.  
COPY KEYBOARD LEVEL  
Used to copy the function program and PLU allocation of one keyboard to another.  
This saves both time and energy on repetitive programming.  
COPY WLU (WINDOW LOOK UP)  
Used to copy the information held against a menu selection window to another, this saves both time and energy  
on repetitive programming.  
197  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
This allows transfer of all of individual files to All, individual, or groups of terminals.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
L1  
1. ALL FILES  
2. SELECT PROGRAM FILES  
13. INGREDIENT INVENTORY  
14. TIME ACTIVATED FUNCTIONS  
15. PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
16. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
17. CUSTOM REPORT  
18. STRING REPORT  
19. PLU STOCK  
20. PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
21. COPY PROGRAM  
22. PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
23. P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
24. NON-PLU CODE  
"
ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓  
DOWNLOADING REGISTER SELECTION  
L1  
REGISTER SELECTION:  
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08  
L1  
1. REGISTER :  
ALL REGISTERS  
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
SELECTED  
09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16  
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24  
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32  
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
ESC Y/N ENT PG UP/DN
DONE:DOWN  
ESC Y/N ENT PG UP/DN
DONE:DOWN  
198  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                             
                             
↑↓  
                                                                                                                   
                                                                                                                   
↑↓  
ESC Y/N ENT PG UP/DN DONE:DOWN  
PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
This allows transfer of all of individual files to All, individual, or groups of terminals. Following  
is the file selections available for download  
DOWNLOADING PROGRAM FILE SELECTION L1  
DOWNLOADING PROGRAM FILE SELECTION L1  
1. REGISTER : ALL REGISTERS  
2. PROGRAM FILE SELECTION  
DATE & TIME  
TRAINING MODE OPTION  
LEVEL/MODIFIER OPTION  
TRACKING FILE OPTION  
KITCHEN PRINTING/VIDEO OPTION  
VALIDATION/SUBTOTAL PRINT OPTION N  
GENERAL PRINTING OPTION  
REPORT PRINTING OPTION  
REPORT OPTION  
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
PLU  
PLU STATUS GROUP  
GROUP  
FUNCTION KEY  
MACRO  
N
N
N
TIME KEEPING OPTION  
E.J. & DETAIL PRINTING OPTION N  
TAX  
N
TARE WEIGHT  
GENERAL FUNCTION OPTION  
TAX OPTION  
N
N
N
N
LOGO MESSAGE  
ESC Y/N ENT PG UP/DN
DONE:DOWN  
DOWNLOADING PROGRAM FILE SELECTION L1  
N
CASH DRAWER OPTION  
N
"
!
ESC Y/N ENT PG UP/D  
DONE:DOWN  
DOWNLOADING PROGRAM FILE SELECTION L1  
ERROR MESSAGE  
N
AUTHORITY LEVEL  
N
N
SYSTEM DESCRIPTOR  
FINANCIAL REPORT DESCRIPTOR  
EMPLOYEE REPORT DESCRIPTOR  
CHEQUE ENDORSEMENT MESSAGE  
GUEST CHECK LOGO MESSAGE  
VALIDATION MESSAGE  
WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
TIME PERIOD  
N
SYSTEM PRINTER CONFIGURATION  
KITCHEN VIDEO ROUTING  
KITCHEN PRINTER ROUTING  
RECEIPT PRINTER ROUTING  
DETAIL PRINTER ROUTING  
INGREDIENT  
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
RECIPE TABLE  
TIME ACTIVATED KEYBOARD LEVEL  
TIME ACTIVATED PRICE LEVEL  
TIME ACTIVATED MACRO  
TIME ACTIVATED STRING REPORT  
EMPLOYEE  
JOBCODE  
PAYRATE  
N
"
ESC Y/N ENT PG UP/DN
DONE:DOWN  
"
ESC Y/N ENT PG UP/DN
DONE:DOWN  
DOWNLOADING PROGRAM FILE SELECTION L1  
DOWNLOADING PROGRAM FILE SELECTION L1  
SHIFT TIME  
N
PRINTER DRIVER  
N
KP TIME PERIOD  
PRODUCT MIX ITEMS  
PRODUCT MIX GROUP TIME PERIOD  
N
BIT MAP IMAGE  
GROUPS BY EMPLOYEE  
MIX & MATCH TABLE  
N
N
N
N
N
CUSTOM REPORT  
N
EDIT FINANCIAL REPORT  
EDIT EMPLOYEE REPORT  
STRING REPORT  
N
N
N
PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
NON-PLU CODE  
N
N
KEYBOARD KEY RELOCATION  
S-MODE SYSTEM OPTION  
N
N
%
"
ESC Y/N ENT PG UP/DN
DONE:DOWN  
199  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                        
                        
P-MODE PROGRAM SCANS  
This function allows you to print copies of the register’s P-Mode programming.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
13. INGREDIENT INVENTORY  
14. TIME ACTIVATED FUNCTIONS  
15. PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
16. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
17. CUSTOM REPORT  
18. STRING REPORT  
19. PLU STOCK  
20. PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
21. COPY PROGRAM  
22. PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
23. P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
24. NON-PLU CODE  
"
ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
L1  
P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
L1  
1. PLU BY RANGE  
13. JOB CODE  
2. PLU BY PLU STATUS GROUP  
3. PLU BY SELECTED PRICE LEVEL  
4. PLU STATUS GROUP BY RANGE  
5. GROUP BY RANGE  
6. ALL FUNCTION KEYS  
7. SYSTEM OPTION  
14. PAY RATE  
15. AUTHORITY LEVEL  
16. PRINTER TABLES & KV ROUTING  
17. INGREDIENT INVENTORY  
18. TIME ACTIVATED FUNCTIONS  
19. PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
20. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
21. CUSTOM REPORT  
8. TAXES  
9. MESSAGES  
10. WINDOW LOOK UP (WLU)  
11.TIME PERIOD  
12 EMPLOYEE
 
BY RANGE  
22. STRING REPORT  
23. PLU STOCK BY RANGE  
24 PLU
 
MINIMUM STOCK BY RANGE  
!
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
"
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓  
200  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
201  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NON PLU CODE PROGRAM  
The NON-PLU Code program must be set if you wish to scan UPCs (using the EAN 13  
code) with embedded prices, weights or quantities.  
Within the EAN 13 code, the first two digits (part a) are used as an identifier and the last digit  
(part c) is used as a check digit. The remaining 10 digits (part b) contain the product code  
and the price (or weight or quantity).  
0 2 1 2 3 4 5 0 0 2 5 0 0  
c) check digit  
a) identifier  
b) product code & price  
There are 11 identifier numbers available for non-PLU code programming: “02” and “20” through “29”.  
The purpose of this program is to define the format of the 10 digit part b for each possible identifier.  
For example:  
The structure of Non PLU identifier “02” can be defined to use 5 digits for the product code and 5  
digits for the price.  
The structure of Non PLU identifier “20” can be defined to use 6 digits for the product code and 4  
digits for the price.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
13. INGREDIENT INVENTORY  
14. TIME ACTIVATED FUNCTIONS  
15. PRODUCT MIX GROUPS  
16. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
17. CUSTOM REPORT  
18. STRING REPORT  
19. PLU STOCK  
20. PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
21. COPY PROGRAM  
22. PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
23. P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
24. NON-PLU CODE  
"
ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
NON-PLU CODE PROGRAMMING  
L1  
NON-PLU# 1 (PLU#02~) PROGRAMMING  
L1  
1. PLU#02~  
2. PLU#20~  
3. PLU#21~  
4. PLU#22~  
5. PLU#23~  
6. PLU#24~  
7. PLU#25~  
8. PLU#26~  
9. PLU#27~  
10. PLU#28~  
11. PLU#29~  
LENGTH OF FIELD 1 (=PLU CODE)  
LENGTH OF FIELD 2  
CONTENT OF FIELD 2  
USE PRICE CHECK DIGIT?  
TAB OR DECIMAL POINT OF FIELD 2  
0
0
PRICE  
N
0
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓  
202  
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓←→  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NON PLU – DEFINITIONS  
Non PLU program is used to define the format of price inclusive weight item barcodes.  
PLU#02, PLU#20 ETC..  
This is the format type of the barcode within this section the barcode layout is defined. The first two digits of the  
barcode define the barcode type  
LENGTH OF FIELD 1 (= PLU CODE)  
The digits immediately following the two digit barcode definition are the manufacturer s product code, this will  
be the PLU code for the item. This can change in length depending on the manufacturer. It is necessary to define  
how many digits are to be used for this format type  
LENGTH OF FIELD 2  
This is usually the price field although there are alternatives. The length of this field can vary for different  
barcode types. The length is defined in this field  
CONTENT OF FIELD 2  
This defines the content of field two the norm is the price although there are variations  
USE PRICE CHECK DIGIT  
Some barcode formats use a check digit to ensure the price of the product has been included within the barcode  
correctly. It must be determined which method is used and programmed in this field  
TAB OR DECIAMAL POINT OF FIELD 2  
This is used to determine the number of decimal places for the price of the product  
203  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                             
                             
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓  
PLU & WLU KEY RELOCATION  
PLU KEYS  
This allocates PLU product numbers to keys, which have been defined as PLU keys within  
the function key program. This will provide one touch button product selling. Each of the five  
levels can have either the same product information or completely different product codes, or  
even a mix of each.  
WLU KEYS (WINDOW LOOK UPS)  
This allocates Window Look Up numbers to keys which have been defined as WLU keys  
within the function key program. This will provide one touch button menu selection.These  
menu windows can contain, products, function key lists, or condiment instructions or a  
combination of any of those. Each of the five levels can have either the same product  
information or completely different product codes, or even a mix of each.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
PLU & WLU KEY RELOCATION  
L1  
1. PLU KEYS  
2. WLU KEYS  
16. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
17. CUSTOM REPORT  
18. STRING REPORT  
19. PLU STOCK  
20. PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
21. COPY PROGRAM  
22. PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
23. P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
24. NON-PLU CODE  
1. KEYBOARD LEVEL 1  
2. KEYBOARD LEVEL 2  
3. KEYBOARD LEVEL 3  
4. KEYBOARD LEVEL 4  
5. KEYBOARD LEVEL 5  
25. PLU & WLU KEY RELOCATION  
26. BITMAP FILE DOWNLOAD  
27. GROUPS BY EMPLOYEE  
%
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
PLU KEY RELOCATION PROGRAMMING  
L1  
PLU KEY RELOCATION PROGRAMMING L1  
KEYBOARD LEVEL 1  
KEYBOARD LEVEL : 1  
KEY POSITION :  
1
CURRENT PLU# 000000000000000001  
•PRESS ANY KEY TO READ AND/OR CHANGE  
CURRENT ASSIGNMENT  
SOUP & ROLL  
OR  
•PRESS ESC TO EXIT  
ESC ENTER  
204  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                   
                                                                   
BITMAP FILE DOWNLOAD  
The bitmap is designed on the PC and transmitted to the terminal using the required polling utility it can then be  
transmitted using program send to other terminals This procedure is used to transmit the bitmap image for the  
printer.  
The same menu option can be accessed for the P-MODE menu.  
Note: Ensure the printer is physically connected the terminal and in a ready  
state.  
P-MODE PROGRAMMING MENU  
L1  
16. MIX & MATCH TABLE  
17. CUSTOM REPORT  
18. STRING REPORT  
19. PLU STOCK  
20. PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
21. COPY PROGRAM  
22. PROGRAM FILE DOWNLOAD  
23. P-MODE PROGRAM SCAN PRINTING  
24. NON-PLU CODE  
25. PLU & WLU KEY RELOCATION  
26. BITMAP FILE DOWNLOAD  
27. GROUPS BY EMPLOYEE  
%
ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
↑↓  
BITMAP FILE DOWNLOAD  
L1  
PORT#1  
PORT#2  
PORT#3  
PORT#4  
PORT#5  
PORT#6  
PORT#7  
Press ENTER on  
the correct port #  
to download the  
bitmap image  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN
↓  
205  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
X-MODE  
206  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
X-MODE MANAGER MENU  
X-MODE MANAGER MENU  
L1  
1. MANAGER OPERATION  
2. X REPORTS  
3. TRAINING  
4. SET DATE & TIME  
5. CASH DECLARATION  
6. KEYBOARD & PRICE LEVEL  
7. TIME CLOCK EDIT  
8. EDIT INVENTORY ITEM  
9. EDIT PLU STOCK  
10. DRAWER ASSIGNMENT  
ENTER ↑ ↓  
MANAGER OPERATION  
Some functions are programmable to only operate when the register is in Manager Operation mode.  
MANAGER CONTROL OF FUNCTIONS INSIDE OF A SALES  
TRANSACTIONS  
If manager control is required to access a function inside of a sale, the message "MANAGER REQUIRED" will  
display when the function is attempted. Turn the key to the X position to perform the restricted function, then  
return the key to the register key position. The indicator MGR will display in the lower left portion of the display  
when the register is in manager operation mode.  
MANAGER CONTROL OF FUNCTIONS OUTSIDE OF A SALES  
TRANSACTION  
If manager control is required to access a function inside of a sale, the message "MANAGER REQUIRED" will  
display when the function is attempted. Turn the key to the X position, select "1 MANAGER OPERATION" to  
perform the restricted function, then return the key to the register key position. The indicator MGR will display  
in the lower left portion of the display when the register is in manager operation  
207  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                            
                                                             
↑ ↓  
X-MODE REPORTS MENU  
Using the reporting screen, reports can be displayed to the screen or printed out  
X-REPORTS  
L1  
REPORT#: 00  
ENTER REPORT NUMBER AND PRESS ENTER  
PRESS ENTER TO VIEW THE REPORT LIST  
PRESS ESC TO RETURN TO THE X-MODE  
MANAGER MENU  
ESC ENTER  
X-REPORT LIST  
L1  
1. FINANCIAL  
2. SALES BY TIME PERIODS  
3. ALL PLUS  
4. FROM/TO PLUS  
5. PLUS BY GROUP  
6. PLUS BY GROUP FOR SELECTED GROUP  
7. TOP 20 PLUS  
8. PLU ZERO SALES  
9. PLU ZERO SALES BY GROUP  
10. PLU SALES BY PRICE LEVEL  
11. MIX AND MATCH  
12. NOT FOUND PLU  
!
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
208  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TRAINING  
The register has various programmable training mode options these included; the ability to  
activate training mode by programming a selected training employee which can operate  
alongside normal registrations opening checks etc.. The checks opened by a training  
employee will be printed on the open check report indicated by [T]. There is also the  
programmable option of a training mode financial report. The following option activates  
training mode for the whole of the terminal  
TRAINING  
TRAINING MODE :  
OFF  
ON  
L1  
ESC ENTER ↑ ↓  
SET DATE & TIME  
The current Date and Time is programmed in this section  
SET DATE & TIME  
L1  
1. TIME : (00:00-23:59)  
13:25  
2. DATE :  
MON 07-12-1999  
3. DATE PRINT :  
MMDDYY•  
ESC ENTER ↑ ↓  
209  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CASH DECLARATION  
When compulsory declaration is set in the program options, the count of monies in drawer  
must be entered here before reports can be taken  
CASH DECLARATION  
L1  
CASH  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
CHEQUE  
MISC TEND#  
TOTAL  
0.00  
CASH CHQ MISC DONE ESC  
0.00  
KEYBOARD & PRICE LEVEL  
The terminal can be set to operate as default on any one of five keyboard levels and twenty  
price bands. The terminal will automatically, use this level and return to this level after any  
other levels have been selected and been completed  
KEYBOARD & PRICE LEVEL  
KEYBOARD LEVEL  
PRICE LEVEL  
(1-5) :  
1
(1-20) : 01  
L1  
ESC DONE ENTER ↑ ↓  
210  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                    
                                                     
↑ ↓ ← →  
TIME CLOCK EDIT  
X/Z1(Daily), X/Z2, X/Z3, X/Z4 or X/Z5 time clock errors can be corrected with this function.  
X/Z1 (DAILY) TIME CLOCK EDIT  
X/Z1 (Daily) time entries can be amended for each operator  
TIME CLOCK EDIT X/Z1(DAILY)  
#1 ANNIE W  
L1  
DATE : MON 07/12/1999  
IN  
OUT  
BRK JOB#  
JOB NAME  
MANAGER  
MANAGER  
12:12 - 12:20  
12:25 - 12:30  
00:00 - 00:00  
00:00 - 00:00  
00:00 - 00:00  
1
0
0
0
0
01  
01  
00  
00  
00  
TIPS :  
00000011.25  
ESC DONE ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
!
X/Z2 - X/Z5 TIME CLOCK EDIT  
The hours work for the each can be amended for each employee  
TIME CLOCK EDIT X/Z2  
L1  
#1 ANNIE W  
MANAGER  
SERVER  
HEAD SERVER  
CASHIER  
0000:13 REG  
0000:00 REG  
0000:00 REG  
0000:00 REG  
0000:00 REG  
0000:00 REG  
0000.00 OT  
0000.00 OT  
0000.00 OT  
0000.00 OT  
0000.00 OT  
0000.00 OT  
TIPS :  
00000011.25  
ESC DONE ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↑ ↓ ← →  
211  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EDIT INVENTORY ITEM  
A menu-explosion type inventory system is set up when PLUs are linked to a recipe#) The X-MODE  
MANAGER MENU to receive, transfer in/out, or enter raw waste for ingredients in this system.  
EDIT INVENTORY ITEM#  
1
L1  
SOUP  
0.500  
ACTUAL INVENTORY  
RECEIPT  
TRANSFER IN  
TRANSFER OUT  
RAW WASTE  
00000.000  
00000.000  
00000.000  
00000.000  
00000.000  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↑ ↓  
ACTUAL INVENTORY  
This is the field for entering the current stock holding  
RECEIPT  
This is the field for entering the quantity delivered  
TRANSFER IN  
This is the field for entering the quantity of goods transferred in  
TRANSFER OUT  
This is the field for entering the quantity of goods transferred out  
RAW WASTE  
This is the field for entering wastage of items  
212  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EDIT PLU STOCK  
PLU stock is a simple inventory system where each whole unit PLU activity subtracts a value  
of "1" from the stock counter. he quantity modifer and stock link PLU programming can be  
used to link together two products so stock is reduced from one item with decimal quantity  
reduction if requird.  
PLU stock applies only to PLUs that are assigned to a PLU status group with the Stock  
PLU? setting set to Y Select PLU STOCK to maintain stock levels on PLUs selected for  
stock unit inventory.  
NOTE: Be careful not to confuse the separate and distinct inventory features  
Recipes and Ingredients – Stock control of components making up a saleable product  
Product Mix Groups usage analysis of a group of saleable products  
PLU Stock – Stock control of saleable products  
PLU STOCK MENU  
L1  
PLU#000000000000000001 STOCK(ADD)  
1. ADD  
2. OVERRIDE  
3. SUBTRACT  
DESCRIPTOR :  
STOCK  
BOTTLE BECKS  
0.00  
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓  
PLU# ESC Y/N ENT PAGE UP/DN
↓←→  
ADD  
This adds to the existing stock figures. Used for deliveries transfers in etc..  
SUBTRACT  
This subtracts for the existing stock figures, Used for Returns, transfers out etc.  
OVERRIDE  
This overwrites the existing stock figures. Used for beginning inventory etc..  
213  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DRAWER ASSIGNMENT PROGRAMMING  
Each employee can be allocated one of three drawer, this allocation can be set using the X-MODE menu or when  
defining employee program. When no drawer is allocated an employee is unable to accept payment for a sale.  
DRAWER ASSIGNEMENT PROGRAMMING  
EMPLOYEE#  
L1  
1
CURRENT DRAWER ASSIGNMENT (0-3)  
1
NOTE : IF ASSIGNMENT IS 0, THEN ONLY  
POSTING TO A TRACKING FILE IS ALLOWED.  
CHECKS PAID AND/OR CASH TRANSACTIONS ARE  
NOT ALLOWED.  
ESC Y/N ENTER PAGE UP/DN ↓←→  
214  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
215  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Z-MODE  
216  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                        
                                                        
↑ ↓  
Z-MODE REPORTING  
The Z mode is used for display/printing of reports, all information can be reset at this stage.  
NOTE Any report which is displayed during Z-MODE reporting will also reset those figure which appear. It is  
also important to report that some feature reports such as FOOD COST have a direct relationship to other reports  
for example resetting the PLU sales will result in no usage imformation printed for products on the food cost  
summary.  
Z-REPORTS  
Z-REPORTS  
L1  
REPORT#: 00  
& ENTER REPORT NUMBER AND PRESS ENTER  
& PRESS ENTER TO VIEW THE REPORT LIST  
ENTER  
Z-REPORT LIST  
L1  
1. FINANCIAL  
2. SALES BY TIME PERIODS  
3. ALL PLUS  
4. FROM/TO PLUS  
5. PLUS BY GROUP  
6. PLUS BY GROUP FOR SELECTED GROUP  
10. PLU SALES BY PRICE LEVEL  
11. MIX AND MATCH  
12. NOT FOUND PLU  
13. EMPLOYEES  
14. INDIVIDUAL EMPLOYEE  
15. EMPLOYEE CURRENTLY SIGNED ON  
!
ESC ENTER PAGE UP/DN  
Note If system option "CONFIRM PRINTING BEFORE RESETTING TOTALS ON Z" is selected, the following  
message appears  
Z REPORT COMPLETED  
SUCCESSFULLY.  
DO YOU WISH TO RESET  
TOTALS?  
.
PRESS DONE TO RESET AND END  
THIS REPORT  
PRESS ESC TO EXIT REPORT  
WITHOUT RESETTING TOTALS  
217  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SAMPLE REPORTS  
218  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REPORT LIST  
NO.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
REPORT NAME  
Financial  
Sales by Time Periods  
All PLUs  
From / To PLUs  
PLUs by Group  
PLUs by Group for Selected Group  
Top 20 PLUs  
PLU Zero Sales  
PLU Zero Sales by Group  
PLU Sales by Price Level  
Mix and Match  
Not Found PLU  
Employees  
Individual Employee  
Employee Currently Signed on  
Groups By Employee  
Groups  
From/To Groups  
Selective Group  
Drawer Totals  
Drawer 1/2/3  
MODE  
INDIVIDUAL / IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 to X5 read only  
X1 to X5 read only  
X1 to X5 read only  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 & Z1 only  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 to X5 read only  
X1 to X5 ead only  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X2 & Z2  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 & Z1  
X1 & Z1  
X1 & Z1  
X1 & Z1  
X1 & Z1  
X1 & Z1  
X1 & Z1  
X1 / Z1 - X2 / Z2  
X1 read only  
X1 / Z1  
X1 read only  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 & Z1  
X1 & Z1  
X1 & Z1  
X1 & Z1  
X1 & Z1  
X1 & Z1  
X1 & Z1  
X1 & Z1  
X1 & Z1  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
51  
52  
53  
54  
55  
56  
57  
58  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
IRC from REG holding data  
IRC from REG holding data  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
at REG holding data  
at REG holding data  
at REG holding data  
at REG holding data  
Labour Groups  
Sales & Labour %  
Daily Sales  
Groups By Time Periods  
Analysis 1 By Time Periods  
Analysis 2 By Time Periods  
Analysis 3 By Time Periods  
Track 1 By Time Periods  
Track 2 By Time Periods  
Track 3 By Time Periods  
Track 4 By Time Periods  
Open Check for Track 1  
Open Check for Track 2  
Open Check for Track 3  
Open Check for Track 4  
Open Check for Selected Employee  
Open Check for Current Employee  
Open Check for Track 1,2,3,&4  
Product Mix  
Product Projections  
Station Totals  
Active Employees – time keeping  
Time Keeping  
Day Shift  
Inventory  
PLU Stock  
Stock by PLU Range  
Stock by Group  
Stock by Individual Group  
Food Cost  
PLU Minimum Stock  
Electronic Journal  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
IRC  
IRC  
IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL  
String Report 1 – as defined by program  
String Report 2 – as defined by program  
String Report 3 – as defined by program  
String Report 4 – as defined by program  
Custom  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 / Z1 - X5 / Z5  
X1 & Z1  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL & IRC  
INDIVIDUAL  
219  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
59  
Pre-Poll – Hard Copy Print Out  
220  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FINANCIAL  
FINANCIAL REPORT  
COUNT  
X1 REPORT  
0003  
DESCRIPTOR  
TOTAL  
----------------------------------------  
+PLU LVL1 TTL  
-PLU LVL1 TTL  
+PLU LVL2 TTL  
-PLU LVL2 TTL  
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
:
+PLU LVL20 TTL  
-PLU LVL20 TTL  
ADJST TTL  
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
NON-TAX  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
TAX1 SALES  
TAX2 SALES  
TAX3 SALES  
TAX4 SALES  
TAX5 SALES  
TAX6 SALES  
TAX1  
TAX2  
TAX3  
TAX4  
TAX5  
TAX6  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
XMPTAX1 SALES  
XMPTAX2 SALES  
XMPTAX3 SALES  
XMPTAX4 SALES  
XMPTAX5 SALES  
XMPTAX6 SALES  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
ANALYSIS1 SALES  
ANALYSIS2 SALES  
ANALYSIS3 SALES  
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
% 1  
% 2  
% 3  
% 4  
% 5  
% 6  
% 7  
% 8  
% 9  
% 10  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
NET SALES  
0
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
CREDIT TAX1  
CREDIT TAX2  
CREDIT TAX3  
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
221  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CREDIT TAX4  
CREDIT TAX5  
CREDIT TAX6  
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
FOOD STMP CREDIT  
0.00  
MDSE RETURN  
ERROR CORRECT  
PREVIOUS VOID  
TRANS VOID  
CANCEL  
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
GROSS SALES  
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
CASH SALES  
CHEQUE SALES  
R/A 1  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0
R/A 2  
R/A 3  
R/A 4  
R/A 5  
P/O 1  
P/O 2  
P/O 3  
P/O 4  
P/O 5  
HASH TOTAL  
AUDACTION  
NO SALE/NON-ADD#  
----------------------------------------  
CASH-IN-DRAWER  
CHEQUE-IN-DRAWER  
F/S-IN-DRAWER  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0
0
MISC1 TEND  
MISC2 TEND  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
:
MISC16 TEND  
0
0.00  
CONV1 CASH  
*0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
*0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
*0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
CONV2 CASH  
CONV3 CASH  
CONV4 CASH  
CONV5 CASH  
CONV1 CHEQUE  
CONV2 CHEQUE  
CONV3 CHEQUE  
CONV4 CHEQUE  
CONV5 CHEQUE  
CONV1 CHARGE  
CONV2 CHARGE  
CONV3 CHARGE  
CONV4 CHARGE  
CONV5 CHARGE  
DRAWER1 TOTAL  
DRAWER2 TOTAL  
DRAWER3 TOTAL  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
PROMO  
WASTE  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
222  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TRAINING TOTAL  
0
0.00  
0.00  
BAL FORWARD  
GUESTS  
PREVIOUS BALANCE  
CHECKS PAID  
SERVICE  
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
TIP TOTAL  
0
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
CASH DEC AMT  
CHEQUE DEC AMT  
MISC1 DEC AMT  
MISC2 DEC AMT  
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
:
MISC15 DEC AMT  
MISC16 DEC AMT  
COUPON SALES  
ROUND TTL  
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
M&M TTL  
AVG. SALES  
----------------------------------------  
GRAND TOTAL(NEG)  
0.00  
0.00  
GRAND TOTAL(NET)  
GRAND TOTAL(GROSS)  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
0.00  
TIME 19:03  
SALES BY TIME PERIODS  
SALES BY TIME PERIOD REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
0003  
TIME PERIOD  
#/CUSTOMERS  
TOTAL  
----------------------------------------  
08:00 - 08:59  
09:00 - 09:59  
11:00 - 11:59  
12:00 - 12:59  
14:00 - 14:59  
3
15  
6
11.54  
186.82  
7.99  
1
2.40  
13  
146.82  
TOTAL  
38  
355.57  
TIME 19:03  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
PLU  
All Plus  
From/To PLUs  
PLUs By Group  
PLUs By Group For Selected Group  
Top 20 PLUs  
ALL PLUS REPORT  
Whole unit reporting if  
there is no decimal activity.  
223  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Total/Counter capacity  
i
b
X1 REPORT  
ITEM  
0003  
PROMO WASTE USAGE  
GROUP# COUNT  
PLU#/%  
TOTAL  
----------------------------------------  
HAMBURGER  
CHEESE BURGER  
TOTAL  
000000000000000001  
1
01  
2
3
6
50.00%  
3.00  
000000000000000002  
1
01  
4
3
8
50.00%  
3.00  
2
6
6
14  
6.00  
TIME 19:03  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
PLU ZERO SALES  
PLU Zero Sales  
PLU Zero Sales By Group  
PLU ZERO SALES REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
ITEM  
0003  
PLU#  
----------------------------------------  
PLU3  
PLU4  
000000000000000003  
000000000000000004  
:
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
224  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLU SALES BY PRICE LEVEL  
PLU SALES BY PRICE LEVEL REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
ITEM  
0003  
PROMO WASTE USAGE  
GROUP# COUNT  
PLU#/%  
TOTAL  
----------------------------------------  
HAMBURGER  
000000000000000001  
1
01  
2
3
3
0
0
0
0
6
50.00%  
3.00  
3.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
PRICE LVL1  
PRICE LVL2  
PRICE LVL3  
PRICE LVL4  
PRICE LVL5  
:
TOTAL  
2
6
6
6
0
0
0
0
14  
6.00  
6.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
PRICE LVL1  
PRICE LVL2  
PRICE LVL3  
PRICE LVL4  
PRICE LVL5  
PRICE LVL6  
PRICE LVL7  
PRICE LVL8  
PRICE LVL9  
PRICE LVL10  
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
PRICE LVL11  
PRICE LVL12  
PRICE LVL13  
PRICE LVL14  
PRICE LVL15  
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
PRICE LVL16  
PRICE LVL17  
PRICE LVL18  
PRICE LVL19  
PRICE LVL20  
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
225  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MIX AND MATCH  
MIX AND MATCH REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
#/DESCRIPTION  
0003  
%
COUNT  
TOTAL  
----------------------------------------  
001 DISCOUNT#1  
002 DISCOUNT#2  
003 DISCOUNT#3  
004 DISCOUNT#4  
005 DISCOUNT#5  
TOTAL  
3
4
0
0
0
7
0.30 20.00  
12.00 80.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
12.30  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
NOT FOUND PLU  
NOT FOUND PLU REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
0003  
DESCRIPTOR  
NOT FOUND PLU#  
----------------------------------------  
CHICKEN NUGGET  
FANTA  
000000000000001000  
000000000000010104  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
226  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EMPLOYEES  
Employees  
Individual Employee  
Employee Currently Signed On  
Active Employees  
INDIVIDUAL EMPLOYEE REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
0003  
EMPLOYEE #1  
DESCRIPTOR  
ANNIE W  
COUNT  
TOTAL  
----------------------------------------  
NET SALES  
NON-TAX  
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
TAX1 SALES  
TAX2 SALES  
TAX3 SALES  
TAX4 SALES  
TAX5 SALES  
TAX6 SALES  
TAX1  
TAX2  
TAX3  
TAX4  
TAX5  
TAX6  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
XMPTAX1 SALES  
XMPTAX2 SALES  
XMPTAX3 SALES  
XMPTAX4 SALES  
XMPTAX5 SALES  
XMPTAX6 SALES  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
ANALYSIS1 SALES  
ANALYSIS2 SALES  
ANALYSIS3 SALES  
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
% 1  
% 2  
% 3  
% 4  
% 5  
% 6  
% 7  
% 8  
% 9  
% 10  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
CREDIT TAX1  
CREDIT TAX2  
CREDIT TAX3  
CREDIT TAX4  
CREDIT TAX5  
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
227  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CREDIT TAX6  
0
0.00  
0.00  
FOOD STMP CREDIT  
MDSE RETURN  
ERROR CORRECT  
PREVIOUS VOID  
TRANS VOID  
CANCEL  
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
GROSS SALES  
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
CASH SALES  
CHEQUE SALES  
R/A 1  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0
R/A 2  
R/A 3  
R/A 4  
R/A 5  
P/O 1  
P/O 2  
P/O 3  
P/O 4  
P/O 5  
HASH TOTAL  
AUDACTION  
NO SALE/NON-ADD#  
----------------------------------------  
CASH-IN-DRAWER  
CHEQUE-IN-DRAWER  
F/S-IN-DRAWER  
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
MISC1 TEND  
MISC2 TEND  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
:
MISC16 TEND  
0
0.00  
CONV1 CASH  
*0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
*0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
*0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
CONV2 CASH  
CONV3 CASH  
CONV4 CASH  
CONV5 CASH  
CONV1 CHEQUE  
CONV2 CHEQUE  
CONV3 CHEQUE  
CONV4 CHEQUE  
CONV5 CHEQUE  
CONV1 CHARGE  
CONV2 CHARGE  
CONV3 CHARGE  
CONV4 CHARGE  
CONV5 CHARGE  
DRAWER1 TOTAL  
DRAWER2 TOTAL  
DRAWER3 TOTAL  
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
PROMO  
WASTE  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
TRAINING TOTAL  
0
0.00  
228  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BAL FORWARD  
GUESTS  
PREVIOUS BALANCE  
CHECKS PAID  
SERVICE  
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
TIP TOTAL  
0
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
ROUND TTL  
M&M TTL  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
TIME 19:03  
GROUPS BY EMPLOYEE  
GROUPS BY EMPLOYEE REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
0003  
EMPLOYEE #1  
DESCRIPTOR  
ANNIE W  
COUNT  
TOTAL  
----------------------------------------  
GROUP1  
GROUP2  
TOTAL  
3
4
7
30.00  
80.00  
110.00  
:
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
229  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GROUP  
Groups  
From/To Groups  
Selective Group  
GROUPS REPORT  
COUNT  
X1 REPORT  
0003  
%
# DESCRIPTOR  
----------------------------------------  
TOTAL  
01 GROUP1  
02 GROUP2  
3
4
30.00 27.27  
80.00 72.72  
GROUP TOTAL  
7
110.00  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
DRAWER TOTALS  
DRAWER TOTALS REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
DESCRIPTOR  
COUNT  
TOTAL  
----------------------------------------  
R/A 1  
R/A 2  
R/A 3  
R/A 4  
R/A 5  
P/O 1  
P/O 2  
P/O 3  
P/O 4  
P/O 5  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
CASH-IN-DRAWER  
CHEQUE-IN-DRAWER  
F/S-IN-DRAWER  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0
0
MISC1 TEND  
MISC2 TEND  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
:
MISC16 TEND  
0
0.00  
CONV1 CASH  
*0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
*0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
CONV2 CASH  
CONV3 CASH  
CONV4 CASH  
CONV5 CASH  
CONV1 CHEQUE  
CONV2 CHEQUE  
CONV3 CHEQUE  
CONV4 CHEQUE  
CONV5 CHEQUE  
230  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONV1 CHARGE  
*0.00  
@0.00  
CONV2 CHARGE  
CONV3 CHARGE  
@0.00  
CONV4 CHARGE  
@0.00  
CONV5 CHARGE  
@0.00  
COUPON SALES  
0
0.00  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
231  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LABOUR GROUPS  
LABOR GROUPS REPORT  
IRC REG#01  
X1 REPORT  
DESCRIPTOR  
0003  
HOURS/MINUTES  
----------------------------------------  
MANAGER  
SERVER  
HEAD SERVER  
CASHIER  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
:
JOB#20  
0.00  
TOTAL TIME WORKED  
0.00  
0.00  
TIME 19:03  
AVG. DAILY LABOR COST  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
SALES AND LABOUR %  
SALES AND LABOR % REPORT  
IRC REG#01  
0001  
X1 REPORT  
TIME PERIOD / ITEM  
----------------------------------------  
00:00 - 00:59  
CUST:  
0 NET SALES:  
AVG/CUST:  
0.00 LABOR COST:  
%/NET SALES:  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
HRS LBR:  
LABOR$/CUST:  
SALES/MANHOUR:  
0.00  
0.00  
:
23:00 - 23:59  
CUST:  
0 NET SALES:  
AVG/CUST:  
0.00 LABOR COST:  
%/NET SALES:  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
HRS LBR:  
LABOR$/CUST:  
SALES/MANHOUR:  
0.00  
0.00  
TOTAL  
CUST:  
0 NET SALES:  
AVG/CUST:  
0.00 LABOR COST:  
%/NET SALES:  
0.00  
0.00  
HRS LBR:  
0.00  
100.00%  
0.00  
LABOR$/CUST:  
SALES/MANHOUR:  
0.00  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
232  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DAILY SALES  
DAILY SALES REPORT  
COUNT  
X2 REPORT  
DAY  
0001  
TOTAL  
----------------------------------------  
1
3
15  
6
1
13  
11.54  
186.82  
7.99  
2.40  
146.82  
2
3
13  
17  
TOTAL  
38  
355.57  
TIME 19:03  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
GROUPS BY TIME PERIOD  
Reporting for each time period and each group. (Selected groups and periods shown here to provide  
format.)  
GROUPS BY TIME PERIODS REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
0001  
TIME PERIOD  
COUNT  
TOTAL AV/TRNS  
----------------------------------------  
00:00-00:59  
DESCRIPTOR  
GROUP1  
0
0.00  
COUNT  
TOTAL  
0.00  
0.00  
0
GROUP2  
0
:
GROUP99  
0
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
:
----------------------------------------  
12:00-12:59  
DESCRIPTOR  
GROUP1  
7
110.00  
COUNT  
15.71  
TOTAL  
30.00  
80.00  
3
4
GROUP2  
:
GROUP99  
0
0.00  
:
----------------------------------------  
TOTAL 110.00 15.71  
7
----------------------------------------  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
ANALYSIS 1 BY TIME PERIODS  
233  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ANALYSIS1 BY TIME PERIODS REPORT  
X1 REPORT 0001  
TIME PERIOD TOTAL  
#/CUSTOMERS  
----------------------------------------  
00:00 - 00:59  
01:00 - 01:59  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
:
23:00 - 23:59  
TOTAL  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
TIME 19:03  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
ANALYSIS 2 BY TIME PERIODS  
ANALYSIS2 BY TIME PERIODS REPORT  
X1 REPORT 0001  
TIME PERIOD TOTAL  
#/CUSTOMERS  
----------------------------------------  
00:00 - 00:59  
01:00 - 01:59  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
:
23:00 - 23:59  
TOTAL  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
TIME 19:03  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
ANALYSIS 3 BY TIME PERIODS  
ANALYSIS3 BY TIME PERIODS REPORT  
X1 REPORT 0001  
TIME PERIOD TOTAL  
#/CUSTOMERS  
----------------------------------------  
00:00 - 00:59  
01:00 - 01:59  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
:
23:00 - 23:59  
TOTAL  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
TIME 19:03  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TRACK BY TIME PERIODS  
234  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Track 1 By Time Periods  
Track 2 By Time Periods  
Track 3 By Time Periods  
Track 4 By Time Periods  
TRACK 1 BY TIME PERIODS REPORT  
X1 REPORT 0001  
TIME PERIOD TOTAL  
#/CUSTOMERS  
----------------------------------------  
00:00 - 00:59  
01:00 - 01:59  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
:
23:00 - 23:59  
TOTAL  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
TIME 19:03  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
OPEN CHECK  
Open Check For Track 1  
Open Check For Track 2  
Open Check For Track 3  
Open Check For Track 4  
Open Check For Selected Employee  
Open Check For Current Employee  
Open Check For Track 1,2,3,&4  
OPEN CHECK FOR TRACK 1 REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
0003  
TBL# CHECK# G# EMPLOYEE  
TIME  
TOTAL  
----------------------------------------  
IRC REG#01  
0001  
0000000100  
TRACK#1 TOTAL  
2
11:11  
ANNIE W  
100.00  
100.00  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
235  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PRODUCT MIX  
PRODUCT MIX REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
0003  
PRODUCT/TIME UNIT#PC  
COUNT  
TOTAL  
----------------------------------------  
BOTTLE BECKS (CASE)  
----------------------------------------  
09:00-09:59 0001#084  
10:00-10:59 0001#033  
13:00-13:59 0002#004  
204  
153  
244  
222.36  
166.77  
265.96  
TOTAL  
0005#001  
601  
655.09  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
PRODUCT PROJECTIONS  
PRODUCT PROJECTIONS REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
0003  
MON  
BOTTLE BECKS  
(CASE)  
----------------------------------------  
TIME  
WEEK1 WEEK2 WEEK3 WEEK4 AVG  
06:00-06:29  
08:00-08:29  
08:30-08:59  
09:30-09:59  
5
10  
0
5
20  
0
5
30  
0
5
5.0  
40 25.0  
700  
175  
0
0
68  
1 17.2  
TOTAL  
15  
25  
103  
746 222.2  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
STATION TOTALS  
Prints for each register in an IRC configuration.  
STATION TOTALS REPORT  
COUNT  
X1 REPORT  
DESCRIPTOR  
0003  
TOTAL  
----------------------------------------  
IRC REG#01  
NET SALES  
14  
1942.68  
1942.68  
1894.00  
38.68  
GROSS SALES  
DRAWER1 TOTAL  
DRAWER2 TOTAL  
DRAWER3 TOTAL  
DRAWER123 TOTAL  
10.00  
1942.68  
236  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
TIME KEEPING  
Time Keeping X/Z1  
TIME KEEPING REPORT  
IRC REG#01  
0003  
X1 REPORT  
EMP#  
SSN  
NAME  
TIPS  
----------------------------------------  
001 NG 5861 34A  
08:30 - 12:30  
13:30 - 17:30  
18:00 - 20:15  
ANNIE W  
5.00  
MANAGER  
MANAGER  
HEAD SERVER  
MANAGER  
8.00 REG  
0.00 OT  
HEAD SERVER  
TOTAL REG  
TOTAL OT  
2.15 REG  
10.15 HR  
0.00 HR  
0.00 OT  
56.92 CST  
0.00 CST  
56.92 CST  
TOTAL LBR  
10.15 HR  
----------------------------------------  
MANAGER  
REG  
8.00 HR  
0.00 HR  
8.00 HR  
47.92 CST  
0.00 CST  
47.92 CST  
OT  
TOTAL LBR  
HEAD SERVER  
REG  
2.15 HR  
0.00 HR  
2.15 HR  
9.00 CST  
0.00 CST  
9.00 CST  
OT  
TOTAL LBR  
TOTAL  
REG  
10.15 HR  
0.00 HR  
10.15 HR  
5.00  
56.92 CST  
0.00 CST  
56.92 CST  
0.00  
OT  
TOTAL LABOR  
TOTAL TIPS  
TIP%  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
Time Keeping X/Z2-5  
TIME KEEPING REPORT  
IRC REG#01  
X2 REPORT  
0003  
237  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EMP#  
SSN  
NAME  
TIPS  
5.00  
----------------------------------------  
001 NG 5861 34A  
MANAGER  
HEAD SERVER  
TOTAL REG  
TOTAL OT  
TOTAL LBR  
ANNIE W  
8.00 REG  
2.15 REG  
10.15 HR  
0.00 HR  
10.15 HR  
0.00 OT  
0.00 OT  
56.92 CST  
0.00 CST  
56.92 CST  
----------------------------------------  
MANAGER  
REG  
8.00 HR  
0.00 HR  
8.00 HR  
47.92 CST  
0.00 CST  
47.92 CST  
OT  
TOTAL LBR  
HEAD SERVER  
REG  
2.15 HR  
0.00 HR  
2.15 HR  
9.00 CST  
0.00 CST  
9.00 CST  
OT  
TOTAL LBR  
TOTAL  
REG  
10.15 HR  
0.00 HR  
10.15 HR  
5.00  
56.92 CST  
0.00 CST  
56.92 CST  
0.00  
OT  
TOTAL LABOR  
TOTAL TIPS  
TIP%  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
238  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DAY SHIFT  
Complete Financial Reporting is available for each of 4 possible shifts. Shifts can be changed automatically at a  
set time or manually.  
DAY SHIFT#1 REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
0003  
00:00-11:59  
TOTAL  
DESCRIPTOR  
COUNT  
----------------------------------------  
+PLU LVL1 TTL  
-PLU LVL1 TTL  
+PLU LVL2 TTL  
-PLU LVL2 TTL  
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
:
+PLU LVL20 TTL  
-PLU LVL20 TTL  
ADJST TTL  
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
NON-TAX  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
TAX1 SALES  
TAX2 SALES  
TAX3 SALES  
TAX4 SALES  
TAX5 SALES  
TAX6 SALES  
TAX1  
TAX2  
TAX3  
TAX4  
TAX5  
TAX6  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
XMPTAX1 SALES  
XMPTAX2 SALES  
XMPTAX3 SALES  
XMPTAX4 SALES  
XMPTAX5 SALES  
XMPTAX6 SALES  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
ANALYSIS1 SALES  
ANALYSIS2 SALES  
ANALYSIS3 SALES  
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
% 1  
% 2  
% 3  
% 4  
% 5  
% 6  
% 7  
% 8  
% 9  
% 10  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
NET SALES  
0
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
CREDIT TAX1  
0
0.00  
239  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CREDIT TAX2  
CREDIT TAX3  
CREDIT TAX4  
CREDIT TAX5  
CREDIT TAX6  
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
FOOD STMP CREDIT  
0.00  
MDSE RETURN  
ERROR CORRECT  
PREVIOUS VOID  
TRANS VOID  
CANCEL  
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
GROSS SALES  
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
CASH SALES  
CHEQUE SALES  
R/A 1  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0
R/A 2  
R/A 3  
R/A 4  
R/A 5  
P/O 1  
P/O 2  
P/O 3  
P/O 4  
P/O 5  
HASH TOTAL  
AUDACTION  
NO SALE/NON-ADD#  
----------------------------------------  
CASH-IN-DRAWER  
CHEQUE-IN-DRAWER  
FD/S-IN-DRAWER  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0
0
MISC1 TEND  
MISC2 TEND  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
:
MISC16 TEND  
0
0.00  
CONV1 CASH  
*0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
*0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
*0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
@0.00  
CONV2 CASH  
CONV3 CASH  
CONV4 CASH  
CONV5 CASH  
CONV1 CHEQUE  
CONV2 CHEQUE  
CONV3 CHEQUE  
CONV4 CHEQUE  
CONV5 CHEQUE  
CONV1 CHARGE  
CONV2 CHARGE  
CONV3 CHARGE  
CONV4 CHARGE  
CONV5 CHARGE  
DRAWER1 TOTAL  
DRAWER2 TOTAL  
DRAWER3 TOTAL  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
240  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PROMO  
WASTE  
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
TRAINING TOTAL  
0
0.00  
0.00  
BAL FORWARD  
GUESTS  
PREVIOUS BALANCE  
CHECKS PAID  
SERVICE  
0
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
TIP TOTAL  
0
0.00  
----------------------------------------  
CASH DEC AMT  
CHEQUE DEC AMT  
MISC1 DEC AMT  
MISC2 DEC AMT  
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
:
MISC15 DEC AMT  
MISC16 DEC AMT  
COUPON SALES  
ROUND TTL  
0
0
0
0
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
241  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INVENTORY  
INVENTORY REPORT  
(01)  
CONSOLIDATED  
X1 REPORT  
0003  
INV #001 PATTY  
----------------------------------------  
BEGINING INVENTORY  
RECEIPTS  
TRANSFER INS  
TRANSFER OUTS  
RAW WASTE  
THEORETICAL USAGE  
ACTUAL INVENTORY  
ACTUAL USAGE  
00.000  
00.000  
00.000  
00.000  
00.000  
00.000  
00.000  
00.000  
----------------------------------------  
VALUE OF INVENTORY  
VARIANCE +/-  
VARIANCE COST  
FOOD COST  
00.000  
00.000  
00.000  
00.000  
:
INVENTORY TOTAL  
----------------------------------------  
PLU RECIPE SALES  
FOOD COST  
VALUE OF INVENTORY  
VARIANCE COST  
00.000  
00.000  
00.000  
00.000  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
242  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INVENTORY DEFINITIONS  
BEGINNING INVENTORY  
The Beginning Quantity as Receipt Quantity entered in X-mode (EDIT INVENTORY ITEM), for the first report.  
Additional reports will get the begin quantity from the END value from the last “Z” reset report.  
RECEIPTS  
The Receipt Quantity as entered in X-mode (EDIT INVENTORY ITEM).  
TRANSFER IN  
The Transfer In Quantity as entered in X-mode (EDIT INVENTORY ITEM)  
TRANSFER OUT  
The Transfer Out Quantity as entered in X-mode (inventory - edit inventory item -daily edit/period)  
RAW WASTE  
The Raw Waste Quantity as entered in X-mode (EDIT INVENTORY ITEM).  
THEORETICAL USAGE  
The Theoretical Use Quantity.  
T.USAGE = [(PROMO + WASTE + SOLD (PLU Report)] * [QTY (RECIPE TABLE)]  
ACTUAL INVENTORY  
The Actual Inventory as entered in X-mode (EDIT INVENTORY ITEM).  
ACTUAL USAGE  
The Actual Use Quantity.  
At the first report,  
A.USAGE = [(RECEIPTS) + (TR/IN) - (TR/OUT) - (RAW WASTE) - (ACTUAL INV.)]  
At the additional reports,  
A.USAGE = [(BEGINNING INV.) + (RECEIPTS) + (TR/IN) - (TR/OUT)  
- (RAW WASTE) - (ACTUAL INV)]  
VALUE OF INVENTORY  
The Value of inventory items on hand. VALUE = [(END) * (COST)]  
VARIANCE +/-  
The Variance +/-. VR+/- = [(T.USAGE) - (A.USAGE)]  
VARIANCE COST  
The Variance Cost. V.CST = [(VR+/-) * (COST)]  
FOOD COST  
The Food Cost. FDCST = [(A.USAGE) * (COST)]  
243  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLU STOCK  
PLUs designated as stock PLUs (see PLU Status Group Programming) will appear on this  
report.  
PLU Stock  
Stock By PLU Range  
PLU STOCK REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
0003  
PLU#  
DESCRIPTOR  
COUNT  
----------------------------------------  
000000000000000001 HAMBURGER  
50  
24  
000000000000000002 CHEESE BURGER  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
PLU STOCK BY GROUP  
Further stock reporting formats are available  
Stock By Group  
Stock By Individual Group  
STOCK BY GROUP REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
GROUP/PLU#  
0003  
DESCRIPTOR  
COUNT  
----------------------------------------  
01 GROUP1  
000000000000000001 HAMBURGER  
000000000000000002 CHEESE BURGER  
GROUP1 TOTAL  
50  
24  
74  
02 GROUP2  
000000000000000011 COKE  
000000000000000012 FANTA  
GROUP2 TOTAL  
100  
67  
167  
----------------------------------------  
TOTAL  
241  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
FOOD COST  
244  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FOOD COST REPORT  
(01)  
CONSOLIDATED  
X1 REPORT  
HAMBURGER  
0003  
1.95  
PRICE  
----------------------------------------  
PLU#000000000000000001  
USAGE COUNT  
ITEM COST  
USAGE COST  
SALES COUNT  
NET SALES  
28  
1.200  
33.600  
28  
54.60  
:
PLU COST TOTAL  
----------------------------------------  
TOTAL FOOD COST  
TOTAL SALES COUNT  
NET SALES TOTAL  
269.850  
133  
1309.35  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
TIME 19:03  
DEFINITIONS  
USAGE COUNT  
(SALES COUNT + PROMO COUNT + WASTE COUNT)  
ITEM COST  
COMBINED COST OF ALL INGREDIENTS\RECIPIES ASSOCIATED WITH THE ITEM.  
USAGE COST  
(USAGE * ITEM COST)  
SALES COUNT  
(SALES COUNT)  
NET SALES  
(SALES COUNT * PRICE)  
245  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLU MINIMUM STOCK  
This report shows PLUs theirs stock counter are less than or equal to minimum stock  
counter  
PLU MINIMUM STOCK REPORT  
X1 REPORT  
0003  
STK  
DESCRIPTOR/PLU#  
MIN.STK  
----------------------------------------  
HAMBURGER  
000000000000000001  
100  
50  
COKE  
000000000000000011  
120  
100  
TIME 19:03  
NO.000013 REG 01 ANNIE W  
ELECTRONIC JOURNAL  
This terminal has a very sophisticated analysis on journal reporting. All information can be selected by individual  
transaction type to be stored and reported extracted as required i.e. all Cash Transactions, VOIDs etc  
CASH TRANSACTIONS  
CHEQUE TRANSACTIONS  
MISC TENDER TRANSACTIONS  
TRANSACTIONS WITH %  
RECD ACCT & PAID OUT  
RETURN TRANSACTIONS  
WITH ERROR CORRECTS & VOIDS  
NO SALES  
- All cash sales made during normal operation  
- All check sales made during normal operation  
- All Miscellaneous tender operations made during normal operation  
- All sales containing a discount or premium operation  
- All received on account or Paid out sales transactions  
- All Merchandise Return sales transactions  
- All Transactions containing an error correct or voids.  
- All Transactions containing no sale operations.  
- All Register Mode cancelled transactions  
CANCEL TRANSACTIONS  
TRANSACTIONS WITH NEGATIVE  
REPORTS  
- All Transactions with negative product sales.  
- All Read & Reset reports which are printed  
- All Program scans which are printed.  
PROGRAM SCANS  
CHECK TRACKING  
- All sales registered for open checks.  
246  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
APPENDIX - TECHNICAL  
247  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BITMAP FILE DOWNLOAD  
This provides a method of printing a graphics logo on the printer, please ensure the necessary memory allocation  
are set at the initial stages as these cannot be re-selected once programming of the terminal has commenced.  
PREPARE THE SPS1000 BITMAP DOWNLOAD  
In the S-Mode MEMORY ALLOCATION, set to Y the STORE BITMAP item..  
This setting must be carried during the initial program reset  
procedure.  
In the S-Mode SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTIONS, set the port where PC is  
connected to POLLING.  
BIT MAP FILE SPECIFICATION  
This procedure states how to save bit map files made using the Microsoft Paint software, and then  
how to down load them to the SPS-1000  
The Maximum file size which can be downloaded to the SPS-1000 is 12288 bytes.  
The Image dimensional definition is as follows  
X * 8 pels (pixels)  
Y * 8  
pels (pixels)  
The possible values of X and Y and the product of X and Y are:  
1<= X <= 255  
1<= Y <= 48  
HOWEVER, the product of X and Y must be  
1<= X*Y <=1536  
A good size to use is 432 pixels wide by 144 pixels high.  
248  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BITMAP FILE DOWNLOAD  
DESIGN & SAVE A LOGO USING MICROSOFT PAINT  
Set the Bit Map size as required (A good size to use is 432 pixels wide by 144 pixels high.)  
Select IMAGE  
Select ATTRIBUTES  
Set Units = PELS  
Set Colors = Black and White  
Enter the width and height of the bit map. Values must be in multiples of 8  
(or above for Bit Map file specifications).  
Design the Bit Map Image. Then prior to saving the Bit Map Image  
Select IMAGE  
Select INVERT COLORS  
Select IMAGE again  
Select FLIP/ROTATE  
Select ROTATE BY ANGLE  
Select 90 DEGREES repeat 2 more times to obtain a rotation of 270 degrees in total.  
Save the Bit Map Image.  
Example:  
Image to Print, (created in Paint Brush)  
Image should be saved as  
249  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PC- SETUP OF A BITMAP  
CONVERTING THE BITMAP FOR THE SPS1000  
Run the CONV_BMP.EXE program  
Enter the filename without the extension (.bmp).  
Output filename is the same and the extension becomes DAT.  
DOWNLOADING THE BITMAP TO THE SPS1000  
Place the file in the appropriate directory. E.g. C:\SPS1000\_ _ 000000  
Rename the file with the extension .dat to BIT_MAP.PGM.  
Run PC utility program by loading the SYSTEM file  
Select the store number this is usually 0000  
Set the environment (i.e. the number of registers etc.)  
Select this option from the TOOL menu option.  
Select FILE UP from the UP menu option  
Enter the File Number 250 to be uploaded then press ENTER key.  
Select FILE DOWN from the DOWN menu option  
Enter the File Number 83 and then press ENTER key.  
DOWNLOADING THE BITMAP FILE TO THE PRINTER  
In the S-Mode SERIAL PORT DEVICE SELECTION, setup the printer as normal.  
Select BITMAP FILE DOWNLOAD in P-MODE.  
Select the port number which the printer is connected and press ENTER  
PRINTING THE BITMAP IMAGE  
The following programming procedures can be found in detail within the programming manual  
In the PRINTER DRIVER SELECTIONS screen in S-mode, select the printer model  
Then delete the INITIALIZE command code.  
In the DEFINE SERIAL PORT PARAMETERS ,set the port for the printer Then set PRINT BITMAP  
to Y.  
Select the LOGO SIZE to be printed.  
It is then required you program a printer to the system using the S-MODE  
To test the printing, make a transaction and then press the RECEIPT ISSUE key.  
PC- FLASH ROM DOWNLOAD  
250  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This is used to transmit a ROM from the PC to one terminal, the s-mode flash ROM download will transmit from  
one terminal to another.  
CAUTION: This will reset all programmed information, setting the machine  
back to the factory default settings  
This will reset the machine back to factory settings, ready to commence program. There a two options for  
resetting, the first will load default setting into the terminal, ready to commence programming. The second will  
prompt for user input of the file sizes. The first option is ideal for setting up demonstrations, the second is  
normally used for custom installations  
This will erase the existing ROM and Transmit a new flash ROM (which has been download from the  
P.C.) down the IRC network  
TO PREPARE RECEIVING TERMINAL  
1. Turn the power switch located on the right side of the register to  
the OFF position.  
2. Turn the key lock to the S-MODE position (one position clockwise  
from the PGM key lock position).  
3. Press and hold the key position where the CASH key is located on  
the default keyboard layout.  
4. Continue to hold the CASH key whilst turning the power switch to  
the ON position. (see figure 1)  
5. Press each of the four corner keys TOP LEFT, BOTTOM LEFT,  
TOP RIGHT, BOTTOM RIGHT (see figure 2)  
6. The screen will say download and is now waiting for the download  
procedure to be activated on the transmitting terminal.  
Figure 1.  
1st  
Figure 2.  
3rd  
7
4
1
0
8
9
6
T E N D  
1
Press and hold  
this key position  
during power-up  
in S-MODE  
Press each of  
the four  
corner keys in  
turn  
C H E Q U E  
5
S U B -  
T O T L  
2
3
.
C A S H  
0 0  
2nd  
4th  
251  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PC- FLASH ROM DOWNLOAD  
TO TRANSMIT FROM THE PC  
PC ROM ERASE  
Using the PC Flash ROM Directory  
Type G_ERA then press ENTER  
Enter the port number for the PC then press ENTER  
Then Enter 5 (or given alternative) then Press ENTER  
The ROM is erased from the terminal this takes approximately 7 seconds  
PC ROM DOWNLOAD  
Using the PC Flash ROM Directory  
Type G-DOWN the press ENTER  
Enter the port number for the PC then press ENTER  
Enter the file name FROM.BIN (or given alternative) then press ENTER  
Enter 0xc20000 (zero ,x, c, two, zero, zero, zero, zero) (or given alternative) then press ENTER  
Note Once the ROM has been successfully downloaded reset the terminal using  
the S-MODE all program reset procedure.  
It is possible to send the ROM to all terminals within the system using the ROM  
DOWNLOAD P-MODE option.  
252  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
APPENDIX - WIRING  
CAUTION:  
SAMSUNG WIRING SPECIFICATIONS MUST BE ADHERED TO AT ALL TIMES  
Always use ferrite cores supplied with register, these should be connected around the cable  
250mm from the serial port on the register  
253  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – SCANNERS  
ZEEBEK SCANNER  
ZEEBEK SCANNER  
SPS1000  
9 PIN ‘D’ Type (Female)  
Blue TXD  
Red CTS  
Yel/Blk GND  
White +5V  
2 RXD  
4 DTR  
5 GND  
9 +5V  
PROGRAMMING.  
SETTINGS  
Baud Rate  
Data Bits  
Stop Bits  
Parity  
2400  
8
1
ODD  
SYMBOL SCANNER  
SYMBOL 1720 SCANNER  
SPS1000  
9 pin D type (female)  
RED  
TXD  
2 RXD  
4 DTR  
5 GND  
9 + 5v  
ORANGE CTS  
BLACK GND  
BROWN + 5v  
PROGRAMMING.  
SETTINGS  
Baud Rate  
Data Bits  
Stop Bits  
Parity  
2400  
8
1
ODD  
254  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – SCANNERS  
METROLOGIC MS700 SCANNER  
Metrologic MS700 Scanner  
SPS1000  
9 Pin D Type (Female)  
25 Pin D Type (female)  
TXD 3  
GND 7  
2 RXD  
5 GND  
PROGRAMMING.  
SETTINGS  
Baud Rate  
Data Bits  
Stop Bits  
Parity  
9600  
7
1
ODD  
METROLOGIC MS951 SCANNER  
METROLOGIC MS951  
SPS1000  
9 Pin D type (Female)  
GREEN  
BROWN GND  
ORANGE + 5v  
TXD  
Pin 2  
Pin 5  
Pin 9  
PROGRAMMING.  
SETTINGS  
Baud Rate  
Data Bits  
Stop Bits  
Parity  
2400  
8
1
ODD  
255  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – PRINTERS  
PRINTER ALL SAMSUNG MODELS  
SPS1000  
PRINTER  
9 Pin ‘D’ type  
(female)  
25 Pin ‘D’ Type (male)  
TXD 3  
RXD 2  
DSR 6  
CTS 8  
DTR 4  
SG 5  
3 RXD  
2 TXD  
20 DTR  
6 DSR  
7 SG  
RJ45- PRINTER ALL SAMSUNG MODELS  
SPS1000  
PRINTER  
8 Pin Modular  
25 Pin ‘D’ Type (male)  
TXD 3  
RXD 4  
DSR 2  
CTS 6  
DTR 8  
SG 7  
3 RXD  
2 TXD  
20 DTR  
6 DSR  
7 SG  
256  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – PC  
TO P.C (VIA MODEM CONNECTION)  
SPS1000  
Full Duplex Modem  
9 Pin “D” Type (Female)  
25 Pin “D” type (Male)  
Frame Ground (Screen)  
TXD  
RXD  
RTS  
CTS  
DSR  
3
2
7
8
6
5
1
4
2
3
4
5
6
TXD  
RXD  
RTS  
CTS  
DSR  
Signal Ground  
DCD  
7 SignalGround  
DCD  
20 DTR  
8
DTR  
DIRECT CABLE TO PC  
SPS1000  
PC  
9 pin  
9 pin  
25 pin  
D type (Female)  
D type (Female)  
RXD 2  
TXD 3  
GND 5  
3 TXD  
2 TXD  
3 RXD  
7 GND  
2 RXD  
5 GND  
257  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – PC RJ45  
NOTE: PC RJ45 cable specification should only be used for distance less than  
1m  
(RJ45) DIRECT CABLE TO PC  
SPS1000  
PC  
8 pin  
9 pin  
25 pin  
Modular  
D type (female)  
RXD 4  
TXD 3  
GND 7  
3 TXD  
2 TXD  
3 RXD  
7 GND  
2 RXD  
5 GND  
258  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – IRC  
TWO TERMINALS  
SPS1000  
SPS1000  
Ethernet Connector  
Ethernet Connector  
Frame Ground (Screen)  
TX+  
TX-  
RX+  
RX-  
1
2
3
3
6
1
2
TX+  
TX-  
RX+  
RX-  
6
TO ETHERNET HUB  
SPS1000  
Ethernet Connector  
SPS1000  
Ethernet Connector  
Frame Ground (Screen)  
TX+  
TX-  
1
2
1
TX+  
2 TX-  
RX+  
RX-  
3
6
3
6
RX+  
RX-  
LOOP BACK CONNECTOR  
If you want to test IRC, use the IRC test in self-test mode  
Loop Back connector  
TX+  
TX-  
1
2
RX+  
RX-  
3
6
259  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – PERIPHERALS  
SAMSUNG POLE DISPLAY  
SPS1000  
POLE DISPLAY  
3 RXD  
5 CTS  
9
RED  
BLUE  
WHITE  
4 – 8 Shorted  
EPSON DP101 / DP102 POLE DISPLAY  
SPS1000  
DP101/102 Pole Display  
9 pin D type (female)  
25 pin D type (male)  
3 RXD  
7 GND  
20 DTR  
TXD 3  
GND 5  
CTS 8  
NOTE: the following dip switch setting for the pole display are required to be on the epsom switch  
1,5, 8  
260  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WIRING SPECIFICATIONS – PERIPHERALS  
PORT LOCATIONS  
DRAWER  
SERIAL PORTS  
IRC  
SERIAL 4-7  
3
2
1
3
2
1
7
6
5
4
SOLDER SIDE TOP  
(EXPANSION RSC232C)  
MAIN PBA  
RS232,IRC AND CASH DRAWER PIN LOCATIONS  
SERIAL 1,2 (D-Sub Male)  
SERIAL 3-7, IRC (RJ45) CASH DRAWER 1-3 (RJ11)  
1 2 3 4  
6 7 8 9  
5
6 5 4 3 2 1  
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1  
PIN#  
SERIAL SERIAL SERIAL SERIAL IRC  
DRAWR DRAWR DRAWR  
PORT 1 PORT 2 PORT 3  
PORT 1 PORT 2 PORT 3 PORT  
4-7  
PORT  
/DCD  
RxD  
NC  
RxD  
Vcc  
/DSR  
NC  
/DSR  
TPTX+  
TPTX-  
FGND  
SELON  
FGND  
SELONI SELONI  
FGND  
1
2
OID (-1) OD (-)  
OD (-1)  
COMP3  
24V  
TxD  
/DTR  
GND  
TxD  
/DTR  
GND  
TxD  
RxD  
NC  
TxD  
RxD  
NC  
TPRX+  
NC  
NC  
COMP1  
24V  
COMP2  
24V  
3
4
5
SELONI SELONI SELONI  
OD (-)  
GND  
OD (-)  
GND  
OD (-1)  
GND  
/DSR  
/RTS  
/CTS  
/DSR  
/RTS  
/CTS  
NC  
GND  
/DTR  
NC  
GND  
/DTR  
TPRX-  
NC  
NC  
6
7
8
RJ-11 (MODULAR 6 PIN)  
Vcc  
Vcc  
9
RJ-45 (MODULAR 8 PIN)  
CONN.  
D-DUB9 (MALE)  
261  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USER NOTES  
262  
SAMSUNG SPS1000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Q See Security Camera QSDS1349H User Guide
Quasar MP3 Player PPX2000 User Guide
RCA Microwave Oven RMW713 WHITE User Guide
Renesas Computer Hardware R8C 1B User Guide
Roland Musical Instrument Fantom G6 User Guide
Ryobi Blower RY08576 User Guide
Ryobi Outdoor Trimmer RPT2543C, RY7011 User Guide
Samsung Network Card BF68 00160B User Guide
Samsung Printer ML 2510 User Guide
Samsung Security Camera PRO4831 User Guide